blob: fa0704cc404576c752047802b12c98cdd54167b5 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000048#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000049#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000050#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000051#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000052#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000053#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000054#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000059#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000060#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000061#include <climits>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000062#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000063using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000064using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000065
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000066STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
67STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
68STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
69STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
70STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000071
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000072namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000073 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
74 : public FunctionPass,
75 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000076 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000077 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000078 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000079 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000080 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000081 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000082 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Dan Gohmanae73dc12008-09-04 17:05:41 +000083 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass(&ID) {}
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000084
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000085 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
86 /// isn't already in it.
87 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
Dan Gohman6b345ee2008-07-07 17:46:23 +000088 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000089 Worklist.push_back(I);
90 }
91
92 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
93 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
94 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
95 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
96
97 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
98 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
99
100 WorklistMap.erase(It);
101 }
102
103 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
104 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
105 Worklist.pop_back();
106 WorklistMap.erase(I);
107 return I;
108 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000109
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000110
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000111 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
112 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
113 /// now.
114 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000115 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000116 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000118 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000119 }
120
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000121 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
122 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
123 ///
124 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000125 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
126 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000127 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000128 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000129
130 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
131 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
132 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
133 ///
134 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
135 ///
136 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
137 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
138
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000139 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
140 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i)) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000141 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000142 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000143 *i = UndefValue::get(Op->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000144 }
145
146 return R;
147 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000148
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000149 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000150 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000151
152 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000153
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000154 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000155 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000156 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000157 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000158 }
159
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000160 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
161
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000162 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
163 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
164 // Return Value:
165 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000166 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000167 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000168 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000169 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000172 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000175 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000176 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000178 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000183 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000186 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
187 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
188 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
189 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000190 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
191 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000192 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
193 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
194 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000195 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
196 Instruction *LHS,
197 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000198 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
199 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000200
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000201 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
202 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000203 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000204 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000205 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
206 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000207 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000208 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
210 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000211 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000212 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000213 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
214 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000215 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
216 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
217 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000218 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000219 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000220 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
221 Instruction *FI);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +0000222 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI);
223 Instruction *visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI, ICmpInst *ICI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000224 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
225 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000226 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
227 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000228 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000229 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000230 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000231 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000232 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000233 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000234 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000235 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000236 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000237 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000238
239 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000240 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000241
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000242 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000243 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000244 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000245 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000246 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
247 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000248 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000249
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000250 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000251 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
252 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
253 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000254 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000255 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
256 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000257 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
258 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000259 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000260 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000261 }
262
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000263 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
264 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
265 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000266 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
267 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000268 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000269
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000270 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000271 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000272
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000273 Instruction *C = CastInst::Create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000274 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000275 return C;
276 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000277
278 Value *InsertBitCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
279 return InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, V, Ty, Pos);
280 }
281
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000282
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000283 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
284 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
285 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
286 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
287 // modified.
288 //
289 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000290 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000291 if (&I != V) {
292 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
293 return &I;
294 } else {
295 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
296 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000297 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000298 return &I;
299 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000300 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000301
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000302 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
303 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
304 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
305 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
306 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
307 //
308 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
309 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
310 if (Old != New)
311 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
312 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000313 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000314 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000315 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000316 return true;
317 }
318
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000319 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
320 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
321 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
322 // this function.
323 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
324 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
325 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000326 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000327 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000328 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
329 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000330
331 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
332 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
333 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
334 }
335
336 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
337 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
338 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
339 }
340 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
341 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
342 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000343
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000344 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000345 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
346 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
347 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
348 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000349 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
350 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000351 Instruction *InsertBefore);
352
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000353 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
354 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000355 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000356
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000357 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
358 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
359 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
360
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000361 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
362 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000363 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
364 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
365 unsigned Depth = 0);
366
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000367 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
368 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
369
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000370 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
371 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
372 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
373 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
374
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000375 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
376 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
377 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
378 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000379 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
380
381
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000382 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
383 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000384
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000385 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000386 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000387 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000388 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000389 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000390 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000391 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000392 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000393 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000394
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000395
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000396 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000397
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000398 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
399 unsigned CastOpc,
400 int &NumCastsRemoved);
401 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
402 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000403
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000404 };
405}
406
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000407char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
408static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
409X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
410
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000411// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000412// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000413static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
414 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
415 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000416 return 3;
417 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000418 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000419 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
420 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000421}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000422
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000423// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
424// it.
425static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000426 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000427}
428
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000429// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
430// though a va_arg area...
431static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000432 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
433 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
434 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000435 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000436 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000437}
438
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000439/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst, a constant
440/// expression bitcast, or a GetElementPtrInst with all zero indices, return the
441/// operand value, otherwise return null.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000442static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
443 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000444 // BitCastInst?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000445 return I->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000446 else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) {
447 // GetElementPtrInst?
448 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
449 return GEP->getOperand(0);
450 } else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000451 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000452 // BitCast ConstantExp?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000453 return CE->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000454 else if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
455 // GetElementPtr ConstantExp?
456 for (User::op_iterator I = CE->op_begin() + 1, E = CE->op_end();
457 I != E; ++I) {
458 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I);
459 if (!CI || !CI->isZero())
460 // Any non-zero indices? Not cast-like.
461 return 0;
462 }
463 // All-zero indices? This is just like casting.
464 return CE->getOperand(0);
465 }
466 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000467 return 0;
468}
469
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000470/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
471/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000472static Instruction::CastOps
473isEliminableCastPair(
474 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
475 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
476 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
477 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
478) {
479
480 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
481 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000482
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000483 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
484 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
485 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000486
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000487 return Instruction::CastOps(
488 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
489 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000490}
491
492/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
493/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
494/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000495static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
496 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000497 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
498
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000499 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000500 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000501 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000502 return false;
503 return true;
504}
505
506/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
507/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
508/// casts that are known to not do anything...
509///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000510Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
511 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000512 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
513 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
514 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000515 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000516
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000517 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000518}
519
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000520// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
521// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000522//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000523// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
524// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
525// binary operators.
526//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000527// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
528// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000529//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000530bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000531 bool Changed = false;
532 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
533 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000534
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000535 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
536 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000537 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
538 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
539 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000540 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
541 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
542 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000543 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
544 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
545 return true;
546 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
547 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
548 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
549 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
550 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
551
552 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000553 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000554 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000555 Op1->getOperand(0),
556 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000557 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000558 I.setOperand(0, New);
559 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
560 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000561 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000562 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000563 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000564}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000565
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000566/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
567/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
568/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
569bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
570 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
571 return false;
572 I.swapOperands();
573 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
574 return true;
575}
576
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000577// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
578// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000579//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000580static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
581 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000582 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000583
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000584 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
585 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
586 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000587
588 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
589 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
590 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
591
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000592 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000593}
594
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000595static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
596 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000597 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000598
599 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000600 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000601 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000602 return 0;
603}
604
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000605// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
606// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000607// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
608// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000609//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000610static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000611 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000612 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000613 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000614 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000615 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000616 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000617 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000618 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000619 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000620 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000621 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000622 return I->getOperand(0);
623 }
624 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000625 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000626}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000627
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000628/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
629/// expression, return it.
630static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
631 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
632 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
633 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
634 return cast<User>(V);
635 return false;
636}
637
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000638/// getOpcode - If this is an Instruction or a ConstantExpr, return the
639/// opcode value. Otherwise return UserOp1.
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000640static unsigned getOpcode(const Value *V) {
641 if (const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000642 return I->getOpcode();
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000643 if (const ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000644 return CE->getOpcode();
645 // Use UserOp1 to mean there's no opcode.
646 return Instruction::UserOp1;
647}
648
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000649/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000650static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000651 APInt Val(C->getValue());
652 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000653}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000654/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000655static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000656 APInt Val(C->getValue());
657 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000658}
659/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
660static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
661 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
662}
663/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
664static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
665 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
666}
667/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
668static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
669 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
670}
671/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
672static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
673 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000674}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000675/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
676/// this size.
677static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
678 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
679 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
680 if (sign) {
681 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
682 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
683 } else {
684 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
685 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
686 }
687
688 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
689
690 if (sign) {
691 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
692 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
693 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
694 } else
695 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
696}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000697
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000698
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000699/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
700/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
701/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
702/// constant and return true.
703static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000704 APInt Demanded) {
705 assert(I && "No instruction?");
706 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
707
708 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
709 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
710 if (!OpC) return false;
711
712 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
713 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
714 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
715 return false;
716
717 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
718 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
719 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
720 return true;
721}
722
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000723// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
724// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
725// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
726// min/max.
727static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000728 const APInt& KnownZero,
729 const APInt& KnownOne,
730 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
731 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
732 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
733 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
734 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
735 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000736 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000737
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000738 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
739 // bit if it is unknown.
740 Min = KnownOne;
741 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
742
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000743 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000744 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
745 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000746 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000747}
748
749// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
750// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
751// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
752// min/max.
753static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000754 const APInt &KnownZero,
755 const APInt &KnownOne,
756 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
757 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000758 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
759 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
760 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
761 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000762 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000763
764 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
765 Min = KnownOne;
766 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
767 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
768}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000769
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000770/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
771/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
772/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
773/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
774/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
775/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
776/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
777/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
778/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
779/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
780/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
781/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
782/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
783/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
784/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
785bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
786 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
787 unsigned Depth) {
788 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
789 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
790 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
791 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
792 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
793 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
794 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
795 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
796 must have same BitWidth");
797 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
798 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
799 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
800 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
801 return false;
802 }
803
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000804 KnownZero.clear();
805 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000806 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
807 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
808 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
809 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
810 return false;
811 }
812 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
813 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
814 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
815 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
816 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
817 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
818 return false;
819 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
820 return false;
821 }
822
823 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
824 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
825
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000826 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
827 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
828 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000829 default:
830 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
831 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000832 case Instruction::And:
833 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
834 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
835 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
836 return true;
837 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
838 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
839
840 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
841 // LHS.
842 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
843 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
844 return true;
845 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
846 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
847
848 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
849 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
850 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
851 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
852 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
853 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
854 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
855 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
856
857 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
858 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
859 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
860
861 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
862 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
863 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
864
865 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
866 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
867 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
868 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
869 break;
870 case Instruction::Or:
871 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
872 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
873 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
874 return true;
875 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
876 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
877 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
878 // LHS.
879 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
880 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
881 return true;
882 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
883 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
884
885 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
886 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
887 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
888 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
889 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
890 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
891 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
892 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
893
894 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
895 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
896 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
897 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
898 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
899 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
900 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
901 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
902
903 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
904 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
905 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
906
907 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
908 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
909 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
910 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
911 break;
912 case Instruction::Xor: {
913 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
914 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
915 return true;
916 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
917 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
918 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
919 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
920 return true;
921 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
922 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
923
924 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
925 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
926 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
927 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
928 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
929 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
930
931 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
932 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
933 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
934 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
935 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
936 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
937
938 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
939 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
940 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
941 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
942 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000943 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000944 I->getName());
945 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
946 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
947 }
948
949 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
950 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
951 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
952 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
953 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
954 // all known
955 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
956 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
957 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000958 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000959 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
960 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
961 }
962 }
963
964 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
965 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
966 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
967 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
968
969 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
970 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
971 break;
972 }
973 case Instruction::Select:
974 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
975 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
976 return true;
977 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
978 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
979 return true;
980 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
981 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
982 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
983 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
984
985 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
986 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
987 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
988 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
989 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
990
991 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
992 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
993 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
994 break;
995 case Instruction::Trunc: {
996 uint32_t truncBf =
997 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +0000998 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
999 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1000 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
1001 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1002 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001003 return true;
1004 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1005 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1006 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1007 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1008 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1009 break;
1010 }
1011 case Instruction::BitCast:
1012 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1013 return false;
1014
1015 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1016 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1017 return true;
1018 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1019 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1020 break;
1021 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1022 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1023 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001024 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001025
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001026 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1027 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1028 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001029 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1030 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001031 return true;
1032 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1033 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1034 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1035 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1036 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1037 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001038 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001039 break;
1040 }
1041 case Instruction::SExt: {
1042 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1043 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001044 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001045
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001046 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001047 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001048
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001049 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001050 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1051 // bit is demanded.
1052 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001053 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001054
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001055 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1056 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1057 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001058 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1059 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001060 return true;
1061 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1062 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1063 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1064 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1065 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1066
1067 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1068 // top bits of the result.
1069
1070 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1071 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001072 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001073 {
1074 // Convert to ZExt cast
1075 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1076 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001077 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001078 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001079 }
1080 break;
1081 }
1082 case Instruction::Add: {
1083 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1084 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1085 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001086 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001087
1088 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1089 // we can do.
1090 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1091 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1092 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1093 if (RHS->isZero())
1094 break;
1095
1096 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1097 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001098 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001099
1100 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1101 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1102 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1103 return true;
1104
1105 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1106 // the constant.
1107 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1108 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1109
1110 // Avoid excess work.
1111 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1112 break;
1113
1114 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1115 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1116 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001117 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001118 I->getName());
1119 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1120 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1121 }
1122
1123 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1124 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1125 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1126 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1127 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1128
1129 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1130 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1131 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001132 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1133 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001134
1135 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1136
1137 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1138 // other, and there is no input carry.
1139 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1140 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1141
1142 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1143 // is no input carry.
1144 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1145 } else {
1146 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1147 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001148 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001149 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1150 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001151 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001152 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1153 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1154 return true;
1155 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1156 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1157 return true;
1158 }
1159 }
1160 break;
1161 }
1162 case Instruction::Sub:
1163 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1164 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001165 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001166 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1167 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001168 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001169 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001170 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1171 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1172 return true;
1173 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1174 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1175 return true;
1176 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001177 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1178 // the known zeros and ones.
1179 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001180 break;
1181 case Instruction::Shl:
1182 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001183 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001184 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1185 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001186 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1187 return true;
1188 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1189 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1190 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1191 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1192 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001193 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001194 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001195 }
1196 break;
1197 case Instruction::LShr:
1198 // For a logical shift right
1199 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001200 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001201
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001202 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001203 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1204 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001205 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1206 return true;
1207 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1208 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001209 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1210 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001211 if (ShiftAmt) {
1212 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001213 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001214 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1215 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001216 }
1217 break;
1218 case Instruction::AShr:
1219 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1220 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1221 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1222 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1223 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1224 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001225 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001226 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1227 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1228 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1229 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001230
1231 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1232 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1233 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1234 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001235
1236 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001237 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001238
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001239 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001240 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001241 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1242 // demanded.
1243 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1244 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001245 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001246 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001247 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1248 return true;
1249 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1250 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1251 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001252 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001253 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1254 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1255
1256 // Handle the sign bits.
1257 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1258 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1259 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1260
1261 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1262 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001263 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001264 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1265 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001266 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001267 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1268 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1269 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1270 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1271 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1272 }
1273 }
1274 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001275 case Instruction::SRem:
1276 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001277 APInt RA = Rem->getValue().abs();
1278 if (RA.isPowerOf2()) {
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001279 if (DemandedMask.ule(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
1280 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1281
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001282 APInt LowBits = RA - 1;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001283 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
1284 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2,
1285 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1286 return true;
1287
1288 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1289 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001290
1291 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001292
1293 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1294 }
1295 }
1296 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001297 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001298 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1299 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001300 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), AllOnes,
1301 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1302 return true;
1303
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001304 uint32_t Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001305 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001306 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1307 return true;
1308
1309 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1310 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1311 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001312 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001313 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001314 case Instruction::Call:
1315 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1316 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1317 default: break;
1318 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1319 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1320 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1321 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1322 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1323
1324 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1325 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1326 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1327 NLZ &= ~7;
1328 NTZ &= ~7;
1329 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1330 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1331 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1332 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1333
1334 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1335 // the right place.
1336 Instruction *NewVal;
1337 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1338 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
1339 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
1340 else
1341 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
1342 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
1343 NewVal->takeName(I);
1344 InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
1345 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1346 }
1347
1348 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1349 break;
1350 }
1351 }
1352 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001353 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001354 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001355 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001356
1357 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1358 // constant.
1359 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1360 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1361 return false;
1362}
1363
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001364
1365/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1366/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1367/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1368/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1369///
1370/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1371/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1372/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1373Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1374 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1375 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001376 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001377 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1378 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001379 assert((DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 && "Invalid DemandedElts!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001380
1381 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1382 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1383 UndefElts = EltMask;
1384 return 0;
1385 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1386 UndefElts = EltMask;
1387 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1388 }
1389
1390 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001391 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1392 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001393 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1394
1395 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1396 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1397 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1398 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1399 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1400 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1401 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1402 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1403 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1404 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1405 }
1406
1407 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001408 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001409 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1410 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001411 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001412 // set to undef.
Mon P Wange0b436a2008-11-06 22:52:21 +00001413
1414 // Check if this is identity. If so, return 0 since we are not simplifying
1415 // anything.
1416 if (DemandedElts == ((1ULL << VWidth) -1))
1417 return 0;
1418
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001419 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001420 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1421 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1422 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1423 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1424 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1425 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001426 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001427 }
1428
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001429 // Limit search depth.
1430 if (Depth == 10)
1431 return false;
1432
1433 // If multiple users are using the root value, procede with
1434 // simplification conservatively assuming that all elements
1435 // are needed.
1436 if (!V->hasOneUse()) {
1437 // Quit if we find multiple users of a non-root value though.
1438 // They'll be handled when it's their turn to be visited by
1439 // the main instcombine process.
1440 if (Depth != 0)
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001441 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1442 return false;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001443
1444 // Conservatively assume that all elements are needed.
1445 DemandedElts = EltMask;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001446 }
1447
1448 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1449 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1450
1451 bool MadeChange = false;
1452 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1453 Value *TmpV;
1454 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1455 default: break;
1456
1457 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1458 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1459 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001460 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001461 if (Idx == 0) {
1462 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1463 // which elt is getting updated.
1464 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1465 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1466 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1467 break;
1468 }
1469
1470 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1471 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001472 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001473 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1474 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1475
1476 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1477 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1478 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1479 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1480 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1481 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1482
1483 // The inserted element is defined.
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001484 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << IdxNo);
1485 break;
1486 }
1487 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
1488 ShuffleVectorInst *Shuffle = cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
1489 uint64_t LeftDemanded = 0, RightDemanded = 0;
1490 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1491 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) {
1492 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1493 if (MaskVal != -1u) {
1494 assert(MaskVal < VWidth * 2 &&
1495 "shufflevector mask index out of range!");
1496 if (MaskVal < VWidth)
1497 LeftDemanded |= 1ULL << MaskVal;
1498 else
1499 RightDemanded |= 1ULL << (MaskVal - VWidth);
1500 }
1501 }
1502 }
1503
1504 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), LeftDemanded,
1505 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1506 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1507
1508 uint64_t UndefElts3;
1509 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), RightDemanded,
1510 UndefElts3, Depth+1);
1511 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1512
1513 bool NewUndefElts = false;
1514 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1515 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
Dan Gohmancb893092008-09-10 01:09:32 +00001516 if (MaskVal == -1u) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001517 uint64_t NewBit = 1ULL << i;
1518 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1519 } else if (MaskVal < VWidth) {
1520 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts2 >> MaskVal) & 1) << i;
1521 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1522 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1523 } else {
1524 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts3 >> (MaskVal - VWidth)) & 1) << i;
1525 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1526 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1527 }
1528 }
1529
1530 if (NewUndefElts) {
1531 // Add additional discovered undefs.
1532 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1533 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; ++i) {
1534 if (UndefElts & (1ULL << i))
1535 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
1536 else
1537 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
1538 Shuffle->getMaskValue(i)));
1539 }
1540 I->setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
1541 MadeChange = true;
1542 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001543 break;
1544 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001545 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001546 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001547 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1548 if (!VTy) break;
1549 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1550 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1551 unsigned Ratio;
1552
1553 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001554 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001555 // elements as are demanded of us.
1556 Ratio = 1;
1557 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1558 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1559 // Untested so far.
1560 break;
1561
1562 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1563 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1564 // elements are live.
1565 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1566 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1567 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1568 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1569 }
1570 } else {
1571 // Untested so far.
1572 break;
1573
1574 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1575 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1576 // live.
1577 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1578 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1579 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1580 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1581 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001582
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001583 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1584 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1585 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1586 if (TmpV) {
1587 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1588 MadeChange = true;
1589 }
1590
1591 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1592 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1593 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1594 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1595 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1596 // undef.
1597 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1598 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1599 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1600 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1601 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1602 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1603 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1604 // elements are undef.
1605 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1606 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1607 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1608 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1609 }
1610 break;
1611 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001612 case Instruction::And:
1613 case Instruction::Or:
1614 case Instruction::Xor:
1615 case Instruction::Add:
1616 case Instruction::Sub:
1617 case Instruction::Mul:
1618 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1619 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1620 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1621 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1622 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1623 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1624 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1625
1626 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1627 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1628 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1629 break;
1630
1631 case Instruction::Call: {
1632 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1633 if (!II) break;
1634 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1635 default: break;
1636
1637 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1638 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1639 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1640 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1641 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1642 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1643 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1644 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1645 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1646 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1647 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1648 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1649 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1650 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1651 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1652 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1653
1654 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1655 // scalarize it now.
1656 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1657 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1658 default: break;
1659 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1660 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1661 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1662 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1663 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1664 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1665 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1666 // Extract the element as scalars.
1667 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1668 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1669
1670 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1671 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1672 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1673 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001674 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001675 II->getName()), *II);
1676 break;
1677 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1678 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001679 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001680 II->getName()), *II);
1681 break;
1682 }
1683
1684 Instruction *New =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001685 InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1686 II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001687 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1688 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1689 return New;
1690 }
1691 }
1692
1693 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1694 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1695 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1696 break;
1697 }
1698 break;
1699 }
1700 }
1701 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1702}
1703
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001704
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001705/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1706/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1707/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1708/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1709/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1710/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1711/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1712///
1713template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman76d402b2008-05-20 01:14:05 +00001714static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001715 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1716 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1717
1718 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1719 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1720 return F.apply(Root);
1721
1722 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1723 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001724 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001725 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1726 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1727
1728 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1729 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1730 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1731 ShouldApply = true;
1732 }
1733
1734 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1735 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1736 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001737 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1738 // and perform the reassociation.
1739 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1740
1741 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1742 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1743
1744 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1745 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001746 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001747 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1748 return 0;
1749 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001750 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001751 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001752 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001753 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001754 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001755
1756 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1757 // get to LHSI.
1758 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1759 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001760 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1761 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001762 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001763 ARI = NextLHSI;
1764
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001765 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1766 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1767 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1768 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1769 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001770
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001771 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1772 // the transformation...
1773 return F.apply(Root);
1774 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001775
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001776 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1777 }
1778 return 0;
1779}
1780
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001781namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001782
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001783// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001784struct AddRHS {
1785 Value *RHS;
1786 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1787 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1788 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001789 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
1790 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001791 }
1792};
1793
1794// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1795// iff C1&C2 == 0
1796struct AddMaskingAnd {
1797 Constant *C2;
1798 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1799 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001800 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001801 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001802 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001803 }
1804 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001805 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001806 }
1807};
1808
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001809}
1810
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001811static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001812 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001813 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001814 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001815 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001816
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001817 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001818 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001819 }
1820
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001821 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001822 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1823 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001824
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001825 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1826 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001827 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1828 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001829 }
1830
1831 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1832 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1833 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1834 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001835 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001836 New = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001837 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001838 New = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001839 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001840 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001841 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001842 abort();
1843 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001844 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1845}
1846
1847// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1848// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1849// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1850// not have a second operand.
1851static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1852 InstCombiner *IC) {
1853 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1854 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1855 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1856 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1857
1858 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001859 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001860 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001861
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001862 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1863 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1864
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001865 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1866 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001867 }
1868 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001869}
1870
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001871
1872/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1873/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1874/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1875Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1876 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001877 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001878 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001879
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001880 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1881 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001882 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001883 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1884 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1885 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1886 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001887 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001888 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1889
1890 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1891 // loop.
1892 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1893 return 0;
1894 }
1895
1896 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1897 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1898 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1899 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1900 if (NonConstBB) {
1901 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1902 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1903 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001904
1905 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001906 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001907 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001908 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001909 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001910
1911 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1912 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1913 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001914 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001915 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001916 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001917 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1918 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1919 else
1920 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001921 } else {
1922 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1923 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001924 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001925 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1926 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001927 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001928 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001929 CI->getPredicate(),
1930 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1931 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001932 else
1933 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1934
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001935 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001936 }
1937 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001938 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001939 } else {
1940 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1941 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001942 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001943 Value *InV;
1944 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001945 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001946 } else {
1947 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001948 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001949 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1950 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001951 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001952 }
1953 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001954 }
1955 }
1956 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1957}
1958
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001959
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00001960/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
1961/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
1962/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
1963/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
1964bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
1965 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
1966 // ones.
1967
1968 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
1969 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
1970 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
1971 // sign extend fine.
1972 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
1973 return true;
1974
1975
1976 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
1977 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
1978 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
1979 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
1980
1981 // TODO: Implement.
1982
1983 return false;
1984}
1985
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001986
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001987Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001988 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001989 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001990
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001991 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001992 // X + undef -> undef
1993 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1994 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1995
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001996 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001997 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001998 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1999 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00002000 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00002001 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
2002 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00002003 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00002004 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002005
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002006 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002007 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002008 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002009 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002010 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002011 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002012
2013 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
2014 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002015 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2016 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2017 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2018 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2019 return &I;
2020 }
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002021
2022 // zext(i1) - 1 -> select i1, 0, -1
2023 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(LHS))
2024 if (CI->isAllOnesValue() &&
2025 ZI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2026 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0),
2027 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()),
2028 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002029 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002030
2031 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2032 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2033 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002034
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002035 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
2036 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00002037 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
2038 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002039 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002040 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002041
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002042 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002043 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
2044 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002045 do {
2046 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002047 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
2048 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002049 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
2050 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002051 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002052 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
2053 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002054 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002055 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002056 }
2057 }
2058 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002059 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2060 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2061 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002062
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002063 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00002064 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
2065 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
2066 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002067 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2068 switch (Size) {
2069 default: break;
2070 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2071 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2072 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2073 }
2074 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002075 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002076 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002077 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002078 }
2079 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002080 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002081
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002082 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2083 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2084
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002085 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002086 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002087 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002088
2089 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2090 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2091 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2092 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2093 }
2094 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2095 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2096 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2097 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2098 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002099 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002100
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002101 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002102 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
2103 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002104 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
2105 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002106 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002107 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002108 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002109 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002110 }
2111
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002112 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002113 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002114
2115 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002116 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2117 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002118 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002119
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002120
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002121 ConstantInt *C2;
2122 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2123 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002124 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002125
2126 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2127 ConstantInt *C1;
2128 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002129 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002130 }
2131
2132 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002133 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002134 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002135
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002136 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002137 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2138 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002139
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002140
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002141 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002142 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002143 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2144 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002145
2146 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2147 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2148 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2149 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2150 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2151 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2152 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2153 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2154 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2155 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2156
2157 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002158 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002159 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002160 }
2161 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002162
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002163 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002164 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002165 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
2166 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2167 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
2168 if (W != Y) {
2169 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002170 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002171 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002172 std::swap(W, X);
2173 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002174 std::swap(Y, Z);
2175 std::swap(W, X);
2176 }
2177 }
2178
2179 if (W == Y) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002180 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, Z,
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002181 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002182 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002183 }
2184 }
2185 }
2186
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002187 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002188 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002189 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002190 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002191
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002192 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2193 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002194 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002195 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2196 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2197 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002198 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002199
2200 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002201 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002202
2203 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002204 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002205
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002206 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2207 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002208 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, CRHS,
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002209 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002210 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002211 }
2212 }
2213 }
2214
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002215 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2216 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002217 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002218 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002219 }
2220
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002221 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002222 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) --> intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002223 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002224 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2225 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002226 if (!CI) {
2227 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2228 Other = LHS;
2229 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002230 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002231 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2232 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002233 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002234 unsigned AS =
2235 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00002236 Value *I2 = InsertBitCastBefore(CI->getOperand(0),
2237 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty, AS), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002238 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(GetElementPtrInst::Create(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002239 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002240 }
2241 }
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002242
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002243 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002244 {
2245 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
2246 Value *Other = RHS;
2247 if (!SI) {
2248 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
2249 Other = LHS;
2250 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002251 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002252 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2253 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002254 Value *A, *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002255
2256 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2257 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002258 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) && match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2259 A == Other) // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002260 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002261 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) && match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2262 A == Other) // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002263 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002264 }
2265 }
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002266
2267 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2268 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2269 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2270 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002271
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002272 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2273 // integer add followed by a sext.
2274 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2275 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2276 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2277 Constant *CI =
2278 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2279 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2280 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
2281 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2282 // Insert the new, smaller add.
2283 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2284 CI, "addconv");
2285 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2286 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2287 }
2288 }
2289
2290 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2291 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2292 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2293 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2294 // integer add will not overflow.
2295 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2296 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2297 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2298 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2299 // Insert the new integer add.
2300 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2301 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2302 "addconv");
2303 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2304 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2305 }
2306 }
2307 }
2308
2309 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2310 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2311 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2312 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2313 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2314 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2315 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2316 // instcombined.
2317 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2318 Constant *CI =
2319 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2320 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2321 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
2322 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2323 // Insert the new integer add.
2324 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2325 CI, "addconv");
2326 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2327 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2328 }
2329 }
2330
2331 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2332 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2333 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2334 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2335 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2336 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2337 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2338 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2339 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2340 // Insert the new integer add.
2341 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2342 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2343 "addconv");
2344 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2345 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2346 }
2347 }
2348 }
2349
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002350 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002351}
2352
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002353Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002354 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002355
Chris Lattnerd137ab42008-07-17 06:07:20 +00002356 if (Op0 == Op1 && // sub X, X -> 0
2357 !I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002358 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002359
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002360 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002361 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002362 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002363
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002364 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2365 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2366 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2367 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2368
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002369 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2370 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002371 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002372 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002373
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002374 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002375 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002376 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002377 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002378
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002379 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2380 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002381 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002382 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002383 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002384 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002385 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002386 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002387 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002388 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002389 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002390 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002391 }
2392 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002393 }
2394 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2395 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2396 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002397 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002398 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002399 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002400 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002401 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002402 }
2403 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002404 }
2405 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002406 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002407
2408 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2409 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002410 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002411 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002412
2413 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2414 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2415 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002416 }
2417
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002418 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2419 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2420
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002421 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2422 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002423 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002424 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002425 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002426 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002427 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002428 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2429 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2430 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002431 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002432 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2433 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002434 }
2435
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002436 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002437 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2438 // is not used by anyone else...
2439 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002440 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002441 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002442 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2443 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2444 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2445 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002446
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002447 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002448 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002449 }
2450
2451 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2452 //
2453 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2454 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2455 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2456
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002457 Value *NewNot =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002458 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
2459 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002460 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002461
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002462 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002463 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002464 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002465 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002466 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002467 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002468 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2469
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002470 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002471 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002472 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002473 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002474 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002475 }
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002476
2477 // X - ((X / Y) * Y) --> X % Y
2478 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
2479 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1I->getOperand(0)))
2480 if (Op0 == I->getOperand(0) &&
2481 Op1I->getOperand(1) == I->getOperand(1)) {
2482 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002483 return BinaryOperator::CreateSRem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002484 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002485 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002486 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002487 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002488 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002489
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002490 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002491 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002492 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002493 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2494 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2495 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2496 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002497 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2498 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002499 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002500 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002501 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002502
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002503 ConstantInt *C1;
2504 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002505 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002506 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002507
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002508 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2509 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002510 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002511 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002512 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002513}
2514
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002515/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2516/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2517/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2518/// signed.
2519static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2520 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002521 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002522 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2523 TrueIfSigned = true;
2524 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002525 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2526 TrueIfSigned = true;
2527 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002528 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2529 TrueIfSigned = false;
2530 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002531 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2532 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2533 TrueIfSigned = true;
2534 return RHS->getValue() ==
2535 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2536 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2537 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2538 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002539 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002540 default:
2541 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002542 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002543}
2544
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002545Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002546 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002547 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002548
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002549 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2550 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2551
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002552 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002553 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2554 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002555
2556 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002557 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002558 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2559 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002560 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002561 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002562
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002563 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002564 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2565 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2566 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2567 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002568 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002569
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002570 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002571 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002572 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002573 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002574 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002575 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002576 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2577 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002578
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002579 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2580 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +00002581 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2582 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2583 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
2584 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
2585 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
2586
2587 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2588 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1))
2589 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantFP>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
2590 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2591 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002592 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002593
2594 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2595 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002596 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002597 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002598 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002599 Op1, "tmp");
2600 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2601 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2602 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002603 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002604
2605 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002606
2607 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2608 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002609 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002610 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002611
2612 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2613 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2614 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002615 }
2616
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002617 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2618 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002619 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002620
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002621 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2622 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2623
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002624 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2625 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2626 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2627 // formed.
2628 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002629 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002630 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002631 BoolCast = CI;
2632 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002633 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002634 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002635 BoolCast = CI;
2636 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002637 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002638 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2639 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002640 bool TIS = false;
2641
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002642 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002643 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2644 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002645 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2646 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002647 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002648 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002649 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002650 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002651 InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002652 BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002653 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2654 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002655
2656 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2657 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002658 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002659 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2660 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002661 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2662 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2663 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2664 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2665 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002666
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002667 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002668 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002669 }
2670 }
2671 }
2672
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002673 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002674}
2675
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002676/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2677/// instruction.
2678bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2679 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2680
2681 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2682 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2683 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2684 if (ST->isNullValue())
2685 NonNullOperand = 2;
2686 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2687 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2688 if (ST->isNullValue())
2689 NonNullOperand = 1;
2690
2691 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2692 return false;
2693
2694 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2695
2696 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2697 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2698
2699 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2700 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2701 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2702 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2703 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2704
2705 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2706 // early exit.
2707 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2708 return true;
2709
2710 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2711 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2712
2713 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2714 --BBI;
2715 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2716 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2717 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2718 break;
2719
2720 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2721 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2722 I != E; ++I) {
2723 if (*I == SI) {
2724 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
2725 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2726 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
2727 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue() :
2728 ConstantInt::getFalse();
2729 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2730 }
2731 }
2732
2733 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2734 if (&*BBI == SI)
2735 SI = 0;
2736 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2737 SelectCond = 0;
2738
2739 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2740 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2741 break;
2742
2743 }
2744 return true;
2745}
2746
2747
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002748/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2749/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2750/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2751/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002752Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002753 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002754
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002755 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2756 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2757 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2758 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2759 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002760 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002761 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002762
2763 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002764 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002765 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002766
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002767 return 0;
2768}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002769
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002770/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2771/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2772/// division instructions.
2773/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002774Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002775 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2776
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002777 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002778 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2779 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2780 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
2781 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
2782 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
2783 }
2784
2785 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
2786 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2787 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002788
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002789 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2790 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002791
2792 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2793 // This does not apply for fdiv.
2794 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2795 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002796
2797 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2798 // div X, 1 == X
2799 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2800 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2801
2802 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2803 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2804 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2805 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002806 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS, I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
2807 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2808 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002809 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002810 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002811 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002812
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002813 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002814 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2815 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2816 return R;
2817 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2818 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2819 return NV;
2820 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002821 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002822
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002823 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002824 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002825 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2826 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2827
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002828 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
2829 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2830 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2831
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002832 return 0;
2833}
2834
2835Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2836 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2837
2838 // Handle the integer div common cases
2839 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2840 return Common;
2841
2842 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2843 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2844 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2845 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002846 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002847 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002848 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002849 }
2850
2851 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002852 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002853 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2854 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002855 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002856 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002857 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002858 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002859 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002860 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002861 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002862 }
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002863 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002864 }
2865 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002866 }
2867
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002868 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2869 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002870 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002871 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002872 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002873 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002874 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002875 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002876 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002877 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2878 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002879 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002880 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2881 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2882
2883 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2884 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002885 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002886 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2887 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002888
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002889 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002890 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002891 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002892 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002893 return 0;
2894}
2895
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002896Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2897 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2898
2899 // Handle the integer div common cases
2900 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2901 return Common;
2902
2903 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2904 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2905 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002906 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002907
2908 // -X/C -> X/-C
2909 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002910 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002911 }
2912
2913 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2914 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002915 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002916 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002917 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002918 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002919 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002920 }
2921 }
2922
2923 return 0;
2924}
2925
2926Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2927 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2928}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002929
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002930/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2931/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2932/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2933/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2934Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002935 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002936
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002937 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002938 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2939 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2940 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2941
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002942 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
2943 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2944 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002945 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002946 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002947 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2948 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002949
2950 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002951 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2952 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002953
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002954 return 0;
2955}
2956
2957/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2958/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2959/// remainder instructions.
2960/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2961Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2962 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2963
2964 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2965 return common;
2966
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002967 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002968 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2969 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2970 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2971
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002972 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2973 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2974
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002975 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2976 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2977 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2978 return R;
2979 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2980 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2981 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002982 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00002983
2984 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
2985 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
2986 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2987 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2988 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2989 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002990 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002991 }
2992
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002993 return 0;
2994}
2995
2996Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2997 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2998
2999 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3000 return common;
3001
3002 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3003 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
3004 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
3005 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
3006 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003007 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003008 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003009 }
3010
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003011 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003012 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
3013 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3014 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00003015 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003016 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003017 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(RHSI, N1,
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003018 "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003019 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003020 }
3021 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003022 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003023
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003024 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
3025 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
3026 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
3027 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
3028 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
3029 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003030 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
3031 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003032 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003033 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003034 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003035 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003036 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003037 }
3038 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003039 }
3040
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003041 return 0;
3042}
3043
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003044Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3045 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3046
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003047 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003048 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3049 return common;
3050
3051 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00003052 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
3053 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
3054 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003055 // X % -Y -> X % Y
3056 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
3057 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
3058 return &I;
3059 }
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00003060
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003061 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003062 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003063 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
3064 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
3065 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3066 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003067 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003068 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003069 }
3070
3071 return 0;
3072}
3073
3074Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003075 return commonRemTransforms(I);
3076}
3077
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003078// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
3079// constant.
3080static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00003081 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003082}
3083
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003084// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
3085// This is the same as lowones(~X).
3086static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00003087 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003088}
3089
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003090/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003091/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3092///
3093/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3094///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003095/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3096/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003097///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003098/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3099/// 0 A > B
3100/// 1 A == B
3101/// 2 A < B
3102///
3103/// <=> Value Definition
3104/// 000 0 Always false
3105/// 001 1 A > B
3106/// 010 2 A == B
3107/// 011 3 A >= B
3108/// 100 4 A < B
3109/// 101 5 A != B
3110/// 110 6 A <= B
3111/// 111 7 Always true
3112///
3113static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3114 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003115 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003116 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3117 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3118 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3119 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3120 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3121 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3122 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3123 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3124 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3125 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003126 // True -> 7
3127 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003128 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003129 return 0;
3130 }
3131}
3132
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003133/// getFCmpCode - Similar to getICmpCode but for FCmpInst. This encodes a fcmp
3134/// predicate into a three bit mask. It also returns whether it is an ordered
3135/// predicate by reference.
3136static unsigned getFCmpCode(FCmpInst::Predicate CC, bool &isOrdered) {
3137 isOrdered = false;
3138 switch (CC) {
3139 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: isOrdered = true; return 0; // 000
3140 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: return 0; // 000
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003141 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: isOrdered = true; return 1; // 001
3142 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3143 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: isOrdered = true; return 2; // 010
3144 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: return 2; // 010
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003145 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: isOrdered = true; return 3; // 011
3146 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3147 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: isOrdered = true; return 4; // 100
3148 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003149 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: isOrdered = true; return 5; // 101
3150 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: return 5; // 101
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003151 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: isOrdered = true; return 6; // 110
3152 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003153 // True -> 7
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003154 default:
3155 // Not expecting FCMP_FALSE and FCMP_TRUE;
3156 assert(0 && "Unexpected FCmp predicate!");
3157 return 0;
3158 }
3159}
3160
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003161/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3162/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003163/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003164/// of predicate to use in the new icmp instruction.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003165static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3166 switch (code) {
3167 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003168 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003169 case 1:
3170 if (sign)
3171 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
3172 else
3173 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3174 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
3175 case 3:
3176 if (sign)
3177 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
3178 else
3179 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3180 case 4:
3181 if (sign)
3182 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
3183 else
3184 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3185 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
3186 case 6:
3187 if (sign)
3188 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
3189 else
3190 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003191 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003192 }
3193}
3194
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003195/// getFCmpValue - This is the complement of getFCmpCode, which turns an
3196/// opcode and two operands into either a FCmp instruction. isordered is passed
3197/// in to determine which kind of predicate to use in the new fcmp instruction.
3198static Value *getFCmpValue(bool isordered, unsigned code,
3199 Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3200 switch (code) {
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003201 default: assert(0 && "Illegal FCmp code!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003202 case 0:
3203 if (isordered)
3204 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS, RHS);
3205 else
3206 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS, RHS);
3207 case 1:
3208 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003209 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT, LHS, RHS);
3210 else
3211 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003212 case 2:
3213 if (isordered)
3214 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ, LHS, RHS);
3215 else
3216 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003217 case 3:
3218 if (isordered)
3219 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE, LHS, RHS);
3220 else
3221 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3222 case 4:
3223 if (isordered)
3224 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT, LHS, RHS);
3225 else
3226 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3227 case 5:
3228 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003229 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE, LHS, RHS);
3230 else
3231 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE, LHS, RHS);
3232 case 6:
3233 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003234 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE, LHS, RHS);
3235 else
3236 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003237 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003238 }
3239}
3240
3241
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003242static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3243 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
3244 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
3245 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
3246 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
3247 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
3248}
3249
3250namespace {
3251// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3252struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003253 InstCombiner &IC;
3254 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003255 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3256 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3257 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3258 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003259 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003260 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3261 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003262 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3263 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003264 return false;
3265 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003266 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3267 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3268 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3269 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3270 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003271 }
3272
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003273 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003274 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003275 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003276 unsigned Code;
3277 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3278 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3279 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3280 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00003281 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003282 }
3283
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003284 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3285 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3286
3287 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003288 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3289 return I;
3290 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3291 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3292 }
3293};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003294} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003295
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003296// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3297// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003298// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003299Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003300 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3301 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003302 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3303 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003304 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003305 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003306 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003307
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003308 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3309 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003310 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003311 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003312 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003313 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003314 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003315 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003316 }
3317 break;
3318 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003319 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3320 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003321
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003322 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3323 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003324 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003325 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003326 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003327 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003328 }
3329 break;
3330 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003331 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003332 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3333 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3334 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003335 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003336
3337 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003338 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003339 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3340 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3341 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003342 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003343
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003344 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3345 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3346 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3347 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3348 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3349 // no effect.
3350 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3351 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3352 return &TheAnd;
3353 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003354 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003355 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003356 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003357 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003358 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003359 }
3360 }
3361 }
3362 }
3363 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003364
3365 case Instruction::Shl: {
3366 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3367 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3368 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003369 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003370 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003371 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3372 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003373
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003374 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3375 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003376 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3377 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003378 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3379 return &TheAnd;
3380 }
3381 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003382 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003383 case Instruction::LShr:
3384 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003385 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3386 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3387 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3388 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003389 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003390 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003391 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3392 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003393
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003394 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3395 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003396 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3397 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3398 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3399 return &TheAnd;
3400 }
3401 break;
3402 }
3403 case Instruction::AShr:
3404 // Signed shr.
3405 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3406 // with an and.
3407 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003408 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003409 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003410 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3411 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003412 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003413 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003414 // Make the argument unsigned.
3415 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003416 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003417 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003418 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003419 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003420 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003421 }
3422 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003423 }
3424 return 0;
3425}
3426
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003427
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003428/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3429/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003430/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3431/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003432/// insert new instructions.
3433Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003434 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3435 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003436 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003437 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003438 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003439
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003440 if (Inside) {
3441 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003442 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003443
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003444 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003445 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003446 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003447 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3448 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3449 }
3450
3451 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3452 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003453 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003454 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003455 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3456 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003457 }
3458
3459 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003460 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003461
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003462 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003463 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003464 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003465 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3466 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3467 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3468 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003469
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003470 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3471 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3472 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003473 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003474 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003475 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3476 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003477}
3478
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003479// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3480// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3481// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3482// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003483static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003484 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003485 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3486 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003487
3488 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003489 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003490 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003491 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003492 return true;
3493}
3494
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003495/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3496/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3497/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003498///
3499/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3500/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3501/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3502///
3503/// return (A +/- B).
3504///
3505Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003506 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003507 Instruction &I) {
3508 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3509 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3510 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3511
3512 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3513
3514 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3515 default: return 0;
3516 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003517 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003518 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003519 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3520 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3521 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003522 break;
3523
3524 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3525 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3526 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003527 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003528 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003529 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003530 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003531 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003532 break;
3533 }
3534 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003535 return 0;
3536 case Instruction::Or:
3537 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003538 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003539 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3540 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003541 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003542 break;
3543 return 0;
3544 }
3545
3546 Instruction *New;
3547 if (isSub)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003548 New = BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003549 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003550 New = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003551 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3552}
3553
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003554Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003555 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003556 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003557
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003558 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3559 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3560
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003561 // and X, X = X
3562 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003563 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003564
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003565 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003566 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003567 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003568 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3569 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3570 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003571 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003572 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003573 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003574 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003575 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003576 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003577 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3578 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003579 }
3580 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003581
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003582 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003583 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3584 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003585
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003586 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003587 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003588 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003589 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3590 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3591 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3592 case Instruction::Xor:
3593 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003594 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3595 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3596 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3597 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003598 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003599 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3600 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003601 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003602 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003603 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003604 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003605 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3606 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003607 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003608 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3609 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003610 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003611 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3612 }
3613 }
3614
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003615 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003616 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003617 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3618 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3619 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3620 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003621 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003622 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003623 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003624 break;
3625
3626 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003627 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3628 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3629 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3630 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003631 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003632
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003633 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
3634 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
3635 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3636 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
3637 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
3638 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
3639
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003640 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003641 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
3642 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003643 Instruction *NewNeg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
3644 InsertNewInstBefore(NewNeg, I);
3645 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
3646 }
3647 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003648 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003649
3650 case Instruction::Shl:
3651 case Instruction::LShr:
3652 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
3653 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00003654 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003655 Instruction *NewICmp = new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0RHS,
3656 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3657 InsertNewInstBefore(NewICmp, I);
3658 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
3659 }
3660 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003661 }
3662
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003663 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003664 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003665 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003666 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003667 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3668 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3669 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3670 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003671 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003672 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003673 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003674 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3675 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003676 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3677 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3678 // other simplifications.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003679 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003680 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3681 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003682 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003683 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003684 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003685 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003686 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003687 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3688 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3689 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003690 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003691 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3692 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3693 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003694 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003695 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003696 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003697
3698 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3699 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003700 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003701 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003702 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3703 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3704 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003705 }
3706
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003707 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3708 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003709
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003710 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3711 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3712
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003713 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003714 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003715 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003716 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003717 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003718 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003719 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003720
3721 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003722 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3723 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003724 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3725 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003726
3727 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3728 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3729 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003730 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003731 }
3732 }
3733
3734 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003735 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3736 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003737
3738 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3739 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3740 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003741 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003742 }
3743 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003744
3745 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3746 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3747 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3748 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3749 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3750 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3751 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3752 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3753 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3754 }
3755 }
3756 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3757 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3758 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3759 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3760 std::swap(A, B);
3761 }
3762 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003763 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(B, "tmp");
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003764 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003765 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003766 }
3767 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003768 }
3769
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003770 { // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3771 // where C is a power of 2
3772 Value *A, *B;
3773 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
Evan Chengab5d5e32008-08-20 23:36:48 +00003774 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
3775 ICmpInst::Predicate RHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003776 if (match(&I, m_And(m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1)),
3777 m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(B), m_ConstantInt(C2)))))
3778 if (C1 == C2 && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3779 C1->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3780 Instruction *NewOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, B);
3781 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOr, I);
3782 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, C1);
3783 }
3784 }
3785
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003786 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3787 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3788 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003789 return R;
3790
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003791 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3792 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003793 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3794 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3795 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3796 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3797 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3798 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3799 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3800 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattnereec8b9a2007-11-22 23:47:13 +00003801 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3802
3803 // Don't try to fold ICMP_SLT + ICMP_ULT.
3804 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) || ICmpInst::isEquality(RHSCC) ||
3805 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ==
3806 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC))) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003807 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneree2b7a42008-01-13 20:59:02 +00003808 ICmpInst::Predicate GT;
3809 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3810 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3811 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
3812 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
3813 else
3814 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3815
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003816 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3817 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003818 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003819 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3820 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3821 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3822 }
3823
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003824 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003825 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3826 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003827 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3828 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3829 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003830 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3831
3832 switch (LHSCC) {
3833 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003834 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003835 switch (RHSCC) {
3836 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003837 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3838 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3839 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003840 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003841 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3842 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3843 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003844 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3845 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003846 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003847 switch (RHSCC) {
3848 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003849 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3850 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3851 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3852 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3853 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3854 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3855 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3856 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3857 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3858 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3859 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003860 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003861 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3862 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003863 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003864 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003865 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3866 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattner424db022007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003867 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3868 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003869 }
3870 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3871 }
3872 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003873 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003874 switch (RHSCC) {
3875 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003876 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3877 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003878 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003879 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3880 break;
3881 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3882 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003883 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003884 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3885 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003886 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003887 break;
3888 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003889 switch (RHSCC) {
3890 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003891 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3892 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003893 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003894 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3895 break;
3896 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3897 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003898 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003899 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3900 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003901 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003902 break;
3903 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3904 switch (RHSCC) {
3905 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Eli Friedman5c1f1722008-06-21 23:36:13 +00003906 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003907 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3908 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3909 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3910 break;
3911 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3912 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3913 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3914 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3915 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3916 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3917 true, I);
3918 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3919 break;
3920 }
3921 break;
3922 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3923 switch (RHSCC) {
3924 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattnera7d1ab02007-11-16 06:04:17 +00003925 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003926 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3927 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3928 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3929 break;
3930 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3931 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3932 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3933 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3934 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3935 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3936 true, I);
3937 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3938 break;
3939 }
3940 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003941 }
3942 }
3943 }
3944
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003945 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003946 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3947 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3948 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3949 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003950 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003951 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003952 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3953 I.getType(), TD) &&
3954 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3955 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003956 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003957 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3958 I.getName());
3959 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003960 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003961 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003962 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003963
3964 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003965 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3966 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3967 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003968 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3969 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3970 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003971 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003972 SI1->getOperand(0),
3973 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003974 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003975 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003976 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003977 }
3978
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003979 // If and'ing two fcmp, try combine them into one.
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003980 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
3981 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3982 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003983 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD) {
3984 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003985 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3986 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3987 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3988 // false.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00003989 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003990 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3991 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS->getOperand(0),
3992 RHS->getOperand(0));
3993 }
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003994 } else {
3995 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
3996 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
3997 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS), m_Value(Op0RHS))) &&
3998 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS), m_Value(Op1RHS)))) {
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003999 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4000 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4001 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4002 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4003 }
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004004 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4005 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) & (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4006 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
4007 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4008 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE ||
4009 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4010 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4011 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4012 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4013 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4014 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4015 bool Op0Ordered;
4016 bool Op1Ordered;
4017 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4018 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4019 if (Op1Pred == 0) {
4020 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4021 std::swap(Op0Pred, Op1Pred);
4022 std::swap(Op0Ordered, Op1Ordered);
4023 }
4024 if (Op0Pred == 0) {
4025 // uno && ueq -> uno && (uno || eq) -> ueq
4026 // ord && olt -> ord && (ord && lt) -> olt
4027 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered)
4028 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4029 // uno && oeq -> uno && (ord && eq) -> false
4030 // uno && ord -> false
4031 if (!Op0Ordered)
4032 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4033 // ord && ueq -> ord && (uno || eq) -> oeq
4034 return cast<Instruction>(getFCmpValue(true, Op1Pred,
4035 Op0LHS, Op0RHS));
4036 }
4037 }
4038 }
4039 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004040 }
4041 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004042
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004043 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004044}
4045
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004046/// CollectBSwapParts - Analyze the specified subexpression and see if it is
4047/// capable of providing pieces of a bswap. The subexpression provides pieces
4048/// of a bswap if it is proven that each of the non-zero bytes in the output of
4049/// the expression came from the corresponding "byte swapped" byte in some other
4050/// value. For example, if the current subexpression is "(shl i32 %X, 24)" then
4051/// we know that the expression deposits the low byte of %X into the high byte
4052/// of the bswap result and that all other bytes are zero. This expression is
4053/// accepted, the high byte of ByteValues is set to X to indicate a correct
4054/// match.
4055///
4056/// This function returns true if the match was unsuccessful and false if so.
4057/// On entry to the function the "OverallLeftShift" is a signed integer value
4058/// indicating the number of bytes that the subexpression is later shifted. For
4059/// example, if the expression is later right shifted by 16 bits, the
4060/// OverallLeftShift value would be -2 on entry. This is used to specify which
4061/// byte of ByteValues is actually being set.
4062///
4063/// Similarly, ByteMask is a bitmask where a bit is clear if its corresponding
4064/// byte is masked to zero by a user. For example, in (X & 255), X will be
4065/// processed with a bytemask of 1. Because bytemask is 32-bits, this limits
4066/// this function to working on up to 32-byte (256 bit) values. ByteMask is
4067/// always in the local (OverallLeftShift) coordinate space.
4068///
4069static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, int OverallLeftShift, uint32_t ByteMask,
4070 SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
4071 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
4072 // If this is an or instruction, it may be an inner node of the bswap.
4073 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4074 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4075 ByteValues) ||
4076 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4077 ByteValues);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004078 }
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004079
4080 // If this is a logical shift by a constant multiple of 8, recurse with
4081 // OverallLeftShift and ByteMask adjusted.
4082 if (I->isLogicalShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4083 unsigned ShAmt =
4084 cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(~0U);
4085 // Ensure the shift amount is defined and of a byte value.
4086 if ((ShAmt & 7) || (ShAmt > 8*ByteValues.size()))
4087 return true;
4088
4089 unsigned ByteShift = ShAmt >> 3;
4090 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
4091 // X << 2 -> collect(X, +2)
4092 OverallLeftShift += ByteShift;
4093 ByteMask >>= ByteShift;
4094 } else {
4095 // X >>u 2 -> collect(X, -2)
4096 OverallLeftShift -= ByteShift;
4097 ByteMask <<= ByteShift;
Chris Lattnerde17ddc2008-10-08 06:42:28 +00004098 ByteMask &= (~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size()));
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004099 }
4100
4101 if (OverallLeftShift >= (int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4102 if (OverallLeftShift <= -(int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4103
4104 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4105 ByteValues);
4106 }
4107
4108 // If this is a logical 'and' with a mask that clears bytes, clear the
4109 // corresponding bytes in ByteMask.
4110 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
4111 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4112 // Scan every byte of the and mask, seeing if the byte is either 0 or 255.
4113 unsigned NumBytes = ByteValues.size();
4114 APInt Byte(I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), 255);
4115 const APInt &AndMask = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getValue();
4116
4117 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumBytes; ++i, Byte <<= 8) {
4118 // If this byte is masked out by a later operation, we don't care what
4119 // the and mask is.
4120 if ((ByteMask & (1 << i)) == 0)
4121 continue;
4122
4123 // If the AndMask is all zeros for this byte, clear the bit.
4124 APInt MaskB = AndMask & Byte;
4125 if (MaskB == 0) {
4126 ByteMask &= ~(1U << i);
4127 continue;
4128 }
4129
4130 // If the AndMask is not all ones for this byte, it's not a bytezap.
4131 if (MaskB != Byte)
4132 return true;
4133
4134 // Otherwise, this byte is kept.
4135 }
4136
4137 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4138 ByteValues);
4139 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004140 }
4141
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004142 // Okay, we got to something that isn't a shift, 'or' or 'and'. This must be
4143 // the input value to the bswap. Some observations: 1) if more than one byte
4144 // is demanded from this input, then it could not be successfully assembled
4145 // into a byteswap. At least one of the two bytes would not be aligned with
4146 // their ultimate destination.
4147 if (!isPowerOf2_32(ByteMask)) return true;
4148 unsigned InputByteNo = CountTrailingZeros_32(ByteMask);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004149
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004150 // 2) The input and ultimate destinations must line up: if byte 3 of an i32
4151 // is demanded, it needs to go into byte 0 of the result. This means that the
4152 // byte needs to be shifted until it lands in the right byte bucket. The
4153 // shift amount depends on the position: if the byte is coming from the high
4154 // part of the value (e.g. byte 3) then it must be shifted right. If from the
4155 // low part, it must be shifted left.
4156 unsigned DestByteNo = InputByteNo + OverallLeftShift;
4157 if (InputByteNo < ByteValues.size()/2) {
4158 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4159 return true;
4160 } else {
4161 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4162 return true;
4163 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004164
4165 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
4166 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004167 if (ByteValues[DestByteNo] && ByteValues[DestByteNo] != V)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004168 return true;
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004169 ByteValues[DestByteNo] = V;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004170 return false;
4171}
4172
4173/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
4174/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
4175Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004176 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004177 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16 ||
4178 // ByteMask only allows up to 32-byte values.
4179 ITy->getBitWidth() > 32*8)
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004180 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004181
4182 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
4183 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00004184 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004185 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004186
4187 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004188 uint32_t ByteMask = ~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size());
4189 if (CollectBSwapParts(&I, 0, ByteMask, ByteValues))
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004190 return 0;
4191
4192 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
4193 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
4194 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
4195
4196 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
4197 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
4198 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
4199 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004200 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004201 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004202 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00004203 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004204}
4205
4206
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004207Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004208 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004209 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004210
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004211 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004212 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004213
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004214 // or X, X = X
4215 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004216 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004217
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004218 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4219 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004220 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4221 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4222 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4223 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4224 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4225 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004226 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4227 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
4228 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
4229 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
4230 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004231 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004232
4233
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004234
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004235 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004236 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004237 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004238 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
4239 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004240 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004241 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004242 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004243 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004244 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004245 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004246
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004247 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
4248 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004249 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004250 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004251 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004252 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004253 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004254 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004255
4256 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4257 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004258 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004259 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004260 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4261 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4262 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004263 }
4264
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004265 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
4266 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004267
4268 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4269 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
4270 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4271 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4272 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
4273 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4274
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004275 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4276 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004277 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004278 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4279 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
4280 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004281 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4282 return BSwap;
4283 }
4284
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004285 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4286 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004287 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004288 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004289 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4290 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004291 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004292 }
4293
4294 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4295 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004296 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004297 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004298 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4299 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004300 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004301 }
4302
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004303 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004304 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004305 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4306 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004307 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4308 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4309 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4310 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4311 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4312 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4313 // replace with V+N.
4314 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4315 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
4316 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4317 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4318 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4319 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4320 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4321 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4322 }
4323 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4324 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
4325 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4326 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4327 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4328 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4329 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4330 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4331 }
4332 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004333 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004334 }
4335
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004336 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4337 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004338 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4339 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4340 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4341 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4342 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4343 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4344 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4345 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4346 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4347
4348 if (V1) {
4349 Value *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004350 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
4351 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004352 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004353 }
Dan Gohmanb493b272008-10-28 22:38:57 +00004354
Bill Wendling1fb43c32008-11-09 23:17:42 +00004355#define SELECT_MATCH(Val) \
4356 m_Select(m_Value(Val), m_ConstantInt(0), m_ConstantInt(-1))
4357#define GET_SELECT_COND(Val) \
4358 cast<User>(Val)->getOperand(0)
4359
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004360 // (A & (C0?-1:0)) | (B & ~(C0?-1:0)) -> C0 ? A : B, and commuted variants
4361 if (match(A, m_Select(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(-1), m_ConstantInt(0)))) {
Bill Wendling1fb43c32008-11-09 23:17:42 +00004362 if (match(D, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(A))))
4363 return SelectInst::Create(GET_SELECT_COND(D), C, B);
4364 if (match(B, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(A))))
4365 return SelectInst::Create(GET_SELECT_COND(B), C, D);
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004366 }
4367 if (match(B, m_Select(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(-1), m_ConstantInt(0)))) {
Bill Wendling1fb43c32008-11-09 23:17:42 +00004368 if (match(C, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(B))))
4369 return SelectInst::Create(GET_SELECT_COND(C), A, D);
4370 if (match(A, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(B))))
4371 return SelectInst::Create(GET_SELECT_COND(A), C, D);
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004372 }
4373 if (match(C, m_Select(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(-1), m_ConstantInt(0)))) {
Bill Wendling1fb43c32008-11-09 23:17:42 +00004374 if (match(D, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(C))))
4375 return SelectInst::Create(GET_SELECT_COND(D), A, B);
4376 if (match(B, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(C))))
4377 return SelectInst::Create(GET_SELECT_COND(B), A, D);
Dan Gohmanb493b272008-10-28 22:38:57 +00004378 }
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004379 if (match(D, m_Select(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(-1), m_ConstantInt(0)))) {
Bill Wendling1fb43c32008-11-09 23:17:42 +00004380 if (match(C, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(D))))
4381 return SelectInst::Create(GET_SELECT_COND(C), A, B);
4382 if (match(A, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(D))))
4383 return SelectInst::Create(GET_SELECT_COND(A), C, B);
Dan Gohmanb493b272008-10-28 22:38:57 +00004384 }
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004385 if (match(A, m_Select(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(0), m_ConstantInt(-1)))) {
Bill Wendling1fb43c32008-11-09 23:17:42 +00004386 if (match(D, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(A))))
4387 return SelectInst::Create(GET_SELECT_COND(D), B, C);
4388 if (match(B, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(A))))
4389 return SelectInst::Create(GET_SELECT_COND(B), D, C);
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004390 }
4391 if (match(B, m_Select(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(0), m_ConstantInt(-1)))) {
Bill Wendling1fb43c32008-11-09 23:17:42 +00004392 if (match(C, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(B))))
4393 return SelectInst::Create(GET_SELECT_COND(C), D, A);
4394 if (match(A, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(B))))
4395 return SelectInst::Create(GET_SELECT_COND(A), D, C);
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004396 }
4397 if (match(C, m_Select(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(0), m_ConstantInt(-1)))) {
Bill Wendling1fb43c32008-11-09 23:17:42 +00004398 if (match(D, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(C))))
4399 return SelectInst::Create(GET_SELECT_COND(D), B, A);
4400 if (match(B, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(C))))
4401 return SelectInst::Create(GET_SELECT_COND(B), D, A);
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004402 }
4403 if (match(D, m_Select(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(0), m_ConstantInt(-1)))) {
Bill Wendling1fb43c32008-11-09 23:17:42 +00004404 if (match(C, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(D))))
4405 return SelectInst::Create(GET_SELECT_COND(C), B, A);
4406 if (match(A, m_Not(SELECT_MATCH(D))))
4407 return SelectInst::Create(GET_SELECT_COND(A), B, C);
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004408 }
Bill Wendling1fb43c32008-11-09 23:17:42 +00004409#undef SELECT_MATCH
4410#undef GET_SELECT_COND
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004411 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004412
4413 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004414 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4415 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4416 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004417 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4418 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4419 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004420 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004421 SI1->getOperand(0),
4422 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004423 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004424 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004425 }
4426 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004427
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004428 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
4429 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004430 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004431 } else {
4432 A = 0;
4433 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004434 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004435 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
4436 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004437 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004438
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004439 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004440 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004441 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, B,
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004442 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004443 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004444 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004445 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004446
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004447 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4448 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4449 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004450 return R;
4451
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004452 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
4453 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004454 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4455 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
4456 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
4457 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
4458 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
4459 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4460 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4461 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004462 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
4463 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4464 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004465 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004466 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004467 bool NeedsSwap;
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00004468 if (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) ? ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)
4469 : ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004470 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004471 else
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004472 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004473
4474 if (NeedsSwap) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004475 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4476 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4477 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4478 }
4479
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004480 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004481 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4482 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004483 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4484 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004485 // equal.
4486 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4487
4488 switch (LHSCC) {
4489 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004490 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004491 switch (RHSCC) {
4492 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004493 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004494 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4495 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004496 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004497 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
4498 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004499 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004500 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004501 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004502 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4503 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4504 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner240d6f42005-04-19 06:04:18 +00004505 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004506 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4507 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4508 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004509 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4510 }
4511 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004512 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004513 switch (RHSCC) {
4514 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004515 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4516 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4517 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004518 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004519 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4520 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4521 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004522 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004523 }
4524 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004525 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004526 switch (RHSCC) {
4527 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004528 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004529 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004530 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004531 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4532 // this can cause overflow.
4533 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4534 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004535 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
4536 false, I);
4537 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4538 break;
4539 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4540 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004541 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004542 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4543 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004544 }
4545 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004546 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004547 switch (RHSCC) {
4548 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004549 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4550 break;
4551 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004552 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4553 // this can cause overflow.
4554 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4555 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004556 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
4557 false, I);
4558 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4559 break;
4560 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4561 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4562 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4563 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4564 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004565 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004566 break;
4567 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4568 switch (RHSCC) {
4569 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4570 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4571 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4572 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4573 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4574 break;
4575 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4576 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004577 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004578 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4579 break;
4580 }
4581 break;
4582 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4583 switch (RHSCC) {
4584 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4585 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4586 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4587 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4588 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4589 break;
4590 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4591 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004592 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004593 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4594 break;
4595 }
4596 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004597 }
4598 }
4599 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004600
4601 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004602 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004603 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004604 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004605 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4606 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4607 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
4608 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
4609 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4610 // generated.
4611 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4612 I.getType(), TD) &&
4613 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4614 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004615 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004616 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4617 I.getName());
4618 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004619 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004620 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004621 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004622 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004623 }
4624
4625
4626 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4627 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4628 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4629 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Chris Lattner5ebd9362008-02-29 06:09:11 +00004630 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004631 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004632 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4633 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4634 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4635 // true.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004636 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004637 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4638
4639 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4640 // rest.
4641 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS->getOperand(0),
4642 RHS->getOperand(0));
4643 }
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004644 } else {
4645 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
4646 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
4647 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS), m_Value(Op0RHS))) &&
4648 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS), m_Value(Op1RHS)))) {
4649 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4650 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4651 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4652 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4653 }
4654 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4655 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) | (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4656 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
4657 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4658 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE ||
4659 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4660 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4661 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4662 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4663 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4664 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4665 bool Op0Ordered;
4666 bool Op1Ordered;
4667 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4668 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4669 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered) {
4670 // If both are ordered or unordered, return a new fcmp with
4671 // or'ed predicates.
4672 Value *RV = getFCmpValue(Op0Ordered, Op0Pred|Op1Pred,
4673 Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4674 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
4675 return I;
4676 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
4677 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RV);
4678 }
4679 }
4680 }
4681 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004682 }
4683 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004684
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004685 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004686}
4687
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004688namespace {
4689
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004690// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4691struct XorSelf {
4692 Value *RHS;
4693 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4694 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4695 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4696 return &Xor;
4697 }
4698};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004699
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004700}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004701
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004702Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004703 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004704 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004705
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004706 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
4707 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
4708 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
4709 // idiom (misuse).
4710 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004711 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004712 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004713
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004714 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4715 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004716 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004717 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004718 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004719
4720 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4721 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004722 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4723 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4724 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4725 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4726 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4727 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004728 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4729 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004730 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004731
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004732 // Is this a ~ operation?
4733 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4734 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4735 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4736 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4737 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4738 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4739 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4740 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4741 Instruction *NotY =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004742 BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004743 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4744 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4745 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004746 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004747 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004748 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004749 }
4750 }
4751 }
4752 }
4753
4754
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004755 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004756 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4757 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4758 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004759 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4760 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004761
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004762 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4763 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4764 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4765 }
4766
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004767 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
4768 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
4769 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
4770 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
4771 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
4772 if (Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) {
4773 if (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode, ConstantInt::getTrue(),
4774 Op0C->getDestTy())) {
4775 Instruction *NewCI = InsertNewInstBefore(CmpInst::Create(
4776 CI->getOpcode(), CI->getInversePredicate(),
4777 CI->getOperand(0), CI->getOperand(1)), I);
4778 NewCI->takeName(CI);
4779 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, NewCI, Op0C->getType());
4780 }
4781 }
4782 }
4783 }
4784 }
4785
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004786 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004787 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004788 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4789 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004790 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4791 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004792 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004793 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004794 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004795
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004796 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004797 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004798 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004799 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004800 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004801 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004802 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004803 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004804 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004805 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004806 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4807 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004808 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004809
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004810 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004811 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4812 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004813 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004814 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4815 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4816 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004817 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004818 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4819 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004820 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004821 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4822 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4823 return &I;
4824 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004825 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004826 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004827 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004828
4829 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4830 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004831 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004832 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004833 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4834 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4835 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004836 }
4837
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004838 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004839 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004840 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004841
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004842 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004843 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004844 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004845
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004846
4847 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4848 if (Op1I) {
4849 Value *A, *B;
4850 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4851 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004852 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004853 I.swapOperands();
4854 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004855 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004856 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004857 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004858 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004859 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4860 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4861 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4862 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4863 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4864 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004865 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004866 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004867 std::swap(A, B);
4868 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004869 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004870 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4871 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4872 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004873 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004874 }
4875
4876 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4877 if (Op0I) {
4878 Value *A, *B;
4879 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4880 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4881 std::swap(A, B);
4882 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4883 Instruction *NotB =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004884 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4885 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004886 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004887 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4888 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4889 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4890 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4891 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4892 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4893 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4894 std::swap(A, B);
4895 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004896 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004897 Instruction *N =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004898 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(A, "tmp"), I);
4899 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(N, Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004900 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004901 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004902 }
4903
4904 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4905 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4906 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4907 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4908 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4909 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004910 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004911 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4912 Op0I->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004913 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004914 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4915 }
4916
4917 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4918 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4919 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4920 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4921 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4922 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004923 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004924 }
4925 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4926 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4927 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4928 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004929 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004930 }
4931
4932 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4933 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4934 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4935 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4936 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4937 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4938 if (A == C)
4939 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4940 else if (A == D)
4941 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4942 else if (B == C)
4943 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4944 else if (B == D)
4945 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4946
4947 if (X) {
4948 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004949 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4950 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004951 }
4952 }
4953 }
4954
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004955 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4956 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4957 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004958 return R;
4959
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004960 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004961 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004962 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004963 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4964 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004965 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004966 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004967 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4968 I.getType(), TD) &&
4969 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4970 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004971 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004972 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4973 I.getName());
4974 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004975 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004976 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004977 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004978 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004979
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004980 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004981}
4982
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004983/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4984/// overflowed for this type.
4985static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004986 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004987 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004988
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004989 if (IsSigned)
4990 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4991 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4992 else
4993 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4994 else
4995 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004996}
4997
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00004998/// SubWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1-In2, returning true if the result
4999/// overflowed for this type.
5000static bool SubWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
5001 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Dan Gohmanbcb37fd2008-09-11 18:53:02 +00005002 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Subtract(In1, In2));
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005003
5004 if (IsSigned)
5005 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
5006 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
5007 else
5008 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
5009 else
5010 return Result->getValue().ugt(In1->getValue());
5011}
5012
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005013/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
5014/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
5015/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
5016static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
5017 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
5018 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005019 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
5020 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005021
5022 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005023 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005024 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005025
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00005026 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
5027 ++i, ++GTI) {
5028 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00005029 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005030 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
5031 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
5032
5033 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5034 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5035 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
5036
5037 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
5038 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005039 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005040 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005041 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005042 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
5043 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
5044 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005045 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005046
5047 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
5048 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
5049 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
5050 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
5051 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
5052 else {
5053 // Emit an add instruction.
5054 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005055 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005056 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005057 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005058 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005059 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005060 // Convert to correct type.
5061 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
5062 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
5063 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
5064 else
5065 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
5066 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
5067 }
5068 if (Size != 1) {
5069 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
5070 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
5071 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
5072 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005073 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005074 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
5075 }
5076
5077 // Emit an add instruction.
5078 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
5079 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
5080 cast<Constant>(Result));
5081 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005082 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005083 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005084 }
5085 return Result;
5086}
5087
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005088
5089/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return an value that can be used to compare of
5090/// the *offset* implied by GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we want
5091/// to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can be
5092/// complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be legal
5093/// to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32). This
5094/// later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed to
5095/// generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
5096///
5097/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
5098///
5099static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
5100 InstCombiner &IC) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005101 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
5102 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
5103
5104 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
5105 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
5106 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
5107 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
5108 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
5109 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
5110 int64_t Offset = 0;
5111 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5112 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
5113 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5114 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5115
5116 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5117 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5118 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5119 } else {
5120 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5121 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5122 }
5123 } else {
5124 // Found our variable index.
5125 break;
5126 }
5127 }
5128
5129 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
5130 // evaluate it the general way.
5131 if (i == e) return 0;
5132
5133 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
5134 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
5135 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
5136 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5137
5138 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
5139 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5140 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
5141 if (!CI) return 0;
5142
5143 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5144 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5145
5146 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5147 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5148 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5149 } else {
5150 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5151 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5152 }
5153 }
5154
5155 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
5156 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
5157 // the index.
5158 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
5159 if (Offset == 0) {
5160 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
5161 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
5162 // computation crosses zero.
5163 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
5164 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx, TD.getIntPtrType(),
5165 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5166 return VariableIdx;
5167 }
5168
5169 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
5170 // the pointer size, so get it.
5171 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
5172
5173 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
5174 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
5175
5176 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
5177 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
5178 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
5179 // multiple of the variable scale.
5180 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
5181 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
5182 return 0;
5183
5184 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
5185 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
5186 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005187 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005188 true /*SExt*/,
5189 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5190 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005191 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005192}
5193
5194
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005195/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005196/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005197Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
5198 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
5199 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005200 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005201
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005202 // Look through bitcasts.
5203 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
5204 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005205
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005206 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
5207 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005208 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005209 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
5210 // know pointers can't overflow. See if we can output an optimized form.
5211 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5212
5213 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
5214 if (Offset == 0)
5215 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005216 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
5217 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005218 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005219 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
5220 // compare the base pointer.
5221 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
5222 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005223 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00005224 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005225 if (IndicesTheSame)
5226 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5227 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
5228 IndicesTheSame = false;
5229 break;
5230 }
5231
5232 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
5233 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005234 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
5235 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005236
5237 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
5238 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005239 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005240 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005241
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005242 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
5243 bool AllZeros = true;
5244 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5245 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5246 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5247 AllZeros = false;
5248 break;
5249 }
5250 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005251 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
5252 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005253
5254 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005255 AllZeros = true;
5256 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5257 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5258 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5259 AllZeros = false;
5260 break;
5261 }
5262 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005263 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005264
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005265 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
5266 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
5267 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
5268 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
5269 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5270 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005271 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
5272 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005273 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005274 NumDifferences = 2;
5275 break;
5276 } else {
5277 if (NumDifferences++) break;
5278 DiffOperand = i;
5279 }
5280 }
5281
5282 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
5283 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005284 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005285 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005286
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005287 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005288 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
5289 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005290 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
5291 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005292 }
5293 }
5294
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005295 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005296 // the result to fold to a constant!
5297 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
5298 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
5299 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
5300 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5301 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005302 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005303 }
5304 }
5305 return 0;
5306}
5307
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005308/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
5309///
5310Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
5311 Instruction *LHSI,
5312 Constant *RHSC) {
5313 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
5314 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
5315
5316 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
5317 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00005318 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005319 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
5320
5321 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
5322 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
5323 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
5324 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5325
5326 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005327 bool LHSUnsigned = isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI);
5328 if (LHSUnsigned)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005329 ++InputSize;
5330
5331 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
5332 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
5333 return 0;
5334
5335 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
5336 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
5337 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
5338 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
5339
5340 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
5341 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5342 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected predicate!");
5343 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005344 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ:
5345 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ;
5346 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005347 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005348 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT:
5349 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5350 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005351 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005352 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE:
5353 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5354 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005355 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005356 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT:
5357 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5358 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005359 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005360 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE:
5361 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5362 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005363 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005364 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE:
5365 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5366 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005367 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
5368 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5369 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
5370 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5371 }
5372
5373 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
5374
5375 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
5376
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005377 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005378 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
5379 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5380
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005381 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5382 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
5383 // and large values.
5384 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5385 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
5386 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5387 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
5388 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
5389 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
5390 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5391 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5392 }
5393 } else {
5394 // If the RHS value is > UnsignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles
5395 // +INF and large values.
5396 APFloat UMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5397 UMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getMaxValue(IntWidth), false,
5398 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5399 if (UMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // umax < 13123.0
5400 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5401 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE)
5402 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5403 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5404 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005405 }
5406
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005407 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5408 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5409 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5410 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5411 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5412 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
5413 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5414 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
5415 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5416 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5417 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005418 }
5419
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005420 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] or
5421 // [0, UMAX], but it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by
5422 // casting the FP value to the integer value and back, checking for equality.
5423 // Don't do this for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005424 Constant *RHSInt = ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
5425 if (!RHS.isZero() &&
5426 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) != RHSC) {
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005427 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust the
5428 // compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards zero
5429 // at this point.
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005430 switch (Pred) {
5431 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected integer comparison!");
5432 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
5433 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5434 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
5435 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005436 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5437 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5438 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> false
5439 if (RHS.isNegative())
5440 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5441 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005442 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5443 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5444 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5445 if (RHS.isNegative())
5446 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5447 break;
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005448 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5449 // (float)int < -4.4 --> false
5450 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5451 if (RHS.isNegative())
5452 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5453 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE;
5454 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005455 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5456 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5457 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5458 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5459 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5460 break;
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005461 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5462 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5463 // (float)int > -4.4 --> true
5464 if (RHS.isNegative())
5465 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5466 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005467 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5468 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5469 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5470 if (RHS.isNegative())
5471 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5472 break;
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005473 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5474 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> true
5475 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5476 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5477 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5478 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
5479 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005480 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5481 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5482 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5483 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5484 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5485 break;
5486 }
5487 }
5488
5489 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5490 // comparison.
5491 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
5492}
5493
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005494Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5495 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005496 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005497
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005498 // Fold trivial predicates.
5499 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
5500 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
5501 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
5502 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5503
5504 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5505 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5506 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5507 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
5508 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5509 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5510 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
5511 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5512 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5513 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5514 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
5515 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5516
5517 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5518 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5519 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5520 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5521 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5522 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
5523 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5524 return &I;
5525
5526 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5527 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5528 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5529 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5530 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5531 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
5532 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5533 return &I;
5534 }
5535 }
5536
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005537 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005538 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005539
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005540 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5541 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005542 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5543 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5544 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5545 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
5546 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005547 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5548 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5549 // True if unordered.
5550 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005551 }
5552 }
5553
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005554 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5555 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5556 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005557 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5558 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5559 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5560 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5561 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5562 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005563 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005564 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5565 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5566 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5567 return NV;
5568 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005569 case Instruction::Select:
5570 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5571 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5572 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5573 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5574 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5575 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5576 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5577 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5578 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5579 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5580 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5581 I.getName()), I);
5582 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5583 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5584 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5585 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5586 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5587 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5588 I.getName()), I);
5589 }
5590 }
5591
5592 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005593 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005594 break;
5595 }
5596 }
5597
5598 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5599}
5600
5601Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5602 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5603 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5604 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5605
5606 // icmp X, X
5607 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005608 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005609 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005610
5611 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005612 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005613
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005614 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005615 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005616 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
5617 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
5618 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005619 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005620 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005621 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005622
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005623 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005624 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005625 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5626 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005627 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005628 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005629 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005630 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005631 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005632 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005633 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005634
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005635 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005636 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005637 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005638 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005639 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005640 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005641 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005642 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005643 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5644 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005645 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005646 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
5647 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5648 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5649 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
5650 }
5651 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5652 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
5653 // FALL THROUGH
5654 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005655 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005656 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005657 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005658 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005659 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5660 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
5661 // FALL THROUGH
5662 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
5663 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5664 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5665 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
5666 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005667 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005668 }
5669
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005670 // See if we are doing a comparison with a constant.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005671 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00005672 Value *A, *B;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005673
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00005674 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
5675 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
5676 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5677 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
5678 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00005679 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005680
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005681 // If we have an icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
5682 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on
5683 // them being folded in the code below.
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005684 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5685 default: break;
5686 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5687 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
5688 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5689 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5690 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5691 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
5692 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5693 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5694 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5695 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
5696 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5697 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5698 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5699 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
5700 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5701 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5702 }
5703
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005704 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
5705 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
5706 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
5707 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
5708
5709 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005710 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005711 bool UnusedBit;
5712 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
5713
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005714 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
5715 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
5716 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005717 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
5718 return &I;
5719
5720 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005721 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
5722 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
5723 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005724 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate()))
5725 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min, Max);
5726 else
5727 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne,Min,Max);
5728
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005729 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
5730 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
5731 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
5732 if (Min == Max)
5733 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(),
5734 ConstantInt::get(Min),
5735 CI));
5736
5737 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
5738 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
5739 const APInt &RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005740 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
5741 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
5742 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5743 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5744 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5745 break;
5746 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5747 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5748 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5749 break;
5750 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005751 if (Max.ult(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005752 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005753 if (Min.uge(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005754 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005755 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
5756 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5757 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
5758 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5759
5760 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
5761 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
5762 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
5763 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005764 break;
5765 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005766 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005767 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005768 if (Max.ule(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005769 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005770
5771 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
5772 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5773 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5774 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5775
5776 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
5777 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
5778 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
5779 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005780 break;
5781 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005782 if (Max.slt(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005783 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerd01bee72008-07-11 06:40:29 +00005784 if (Min.sge(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005785 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005786 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
5787 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera8ff4a82008-07-11 06:36:01 +00005788 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
Chris Lattnerf9685ac2008-07-11 06:38:16 +00005789 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005790 break;
5791 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005792 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005793 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005794 if (Max.sle(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005795 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005796
5797 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
5798 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5799 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5800 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005801 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005802 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005803 }
5804
5805 // Test if the ICmpInst instruction is used exclusively by a select as
5806 // part of a minimum or maximum operation. If so, refrain from doing
5807 // any other folding. This helps out other analyses which understand
5808 // non-obfuscated minimum and maximum idioms, such as ScalarEvolution
5809 // and CodeGen. And in this case, at least one of the comparison
5810 // operands has at least one user besides the compare (the select),
5811 // which would often largely negate the benefit of folding anyway.
5812 if (I.hasOneUse())
5813 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(*I.use_begin()))
5814 if ((SI->getOperand(1) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(2) == Op1) ||
5815 (SI->getOperand(2) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(1) == Op1))
5816 return 0;
5817
5818 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
5819 // can be folded into the comparison.
5820 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005821 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005822 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005823 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00005824 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005825 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
5826 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005827 }
5828
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005829 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005830 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5831 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5832 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005833 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5834 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005835 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005836 bool isAllZeros = true;
5837 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5838 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5839 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5840 isAllZeros = false;
5841 break;
5842 }
5843 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005844 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005845 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5846 }
5847 break;
5848
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005849 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005850 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5851 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5852 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5853 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5854 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5855 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005856 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005857 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005858 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5859 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5860 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5861 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5862 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5863 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5864 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005865 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5866 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5867 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5868 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5869 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005870 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5871 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005872 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5873 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5874 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5875 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5876 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005877 }
5878 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005879
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005880 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005881 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005882 break;
5883 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005884 case Instruction::Malloc:
5885 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
5886 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
5887 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
5888 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5889 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005890 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005891 }
5892 break;
5893 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005894 }
5895
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005896 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005897 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005898 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005899 return NI;
5900 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005901 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5902 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005903 return NI;
5904
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005905 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005906 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5907 // now.
5908 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5909 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5910 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005911 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5912 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005913 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005914
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005915 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5916 // so eliminate it as well.
5917 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5918 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005919
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005920 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005921 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005922 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005923 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005924 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005925 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00005926 Op1 = InsertBitCastBefore(Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005927 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005928 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005929 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005930 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005931 }
5932
5933 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005934 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005935 // This comes up when you have code like
5936 // int X = A < B;
5937 // if (X) ...
5938 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005939 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5940 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005941 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005942 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005943 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005944
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005945 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
5946 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5947 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005948 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
5949 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5950 I.isEquality()) {
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00005951 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005952 default: break;
5953 case Instruction::Add:
5954 case Instruction::Sub:
5955 case Instruction::Xor:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005956 // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
5957 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
5958 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005959 break;
5960 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005961 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
5962 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
5963 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
5964 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
5965 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
5966 ConstantInt *Mask = ConstantInt::get(
5967 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
5968 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005969 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005970 Instruction *And1 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0),
5971 Mask);
5972 Instruction *And2 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0),
5973 Mask);
5974 InsertNewInstBefore(And1, I);
5975 InsertNewInstBefore(And2, I);
5976 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005977 }
5978 }
5979 break;
5980 }
5981 }
5982 }
5983 }
5984
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005985 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
5986 { Value *A, *B;
5987 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
5988 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
5989 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
5990 }
5991
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005992 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005993 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005994
5995 // -x == -y --> x == y
5996 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
5997 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
5998 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
5999
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006000 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
6001 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
6002 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
6003 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
6004 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
6005 }
6006
6007 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
6008 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
6009 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
6010 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
6011 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00006012 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006013 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006014 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
6015 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
6016 }
6017
6018 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
6019 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
6020 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
6021 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
6022 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
6023 }
6024 }
6025
6026 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
6027 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006028 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
6029 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006030 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
6031 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006032 }
6033 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006034 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006035 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
6036 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006037 }
6038 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006039 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006040 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
6041 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006042 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006043
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006044 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
6045 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
6046 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
6047 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
6048 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
6049
6050 if (A == C) {
6051 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
6052 } else if (A == D) {
6053 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
6054 } else if (B == C) {
6055 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
6056 } else if (B == D) {
6057 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
6058 }
6059
6060 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006061 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
6062 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006063 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
6064 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
6065 return &I;
6066 }
6067 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006068 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006069 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006070}
6071
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006072
6073/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
6074/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
6075Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
6076 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
6077 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6078 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
6079
6080 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
6081 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
6082 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
6083 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
6084 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
6085 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
6086 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
6087 // if it finds it.
6088 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
6089 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
6090 return 0;
6091 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006092 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006093 if (DivIsSigned && DivRHS->isAllOnesValue())
6094 return 0; // The overflow computation also screws up here
6095 if (DivRHS->isOne())
6096 return 0; // Not worth bothering, and eliminates some funny cases
6097 // with INT_MIN.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006098
6099 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
6100 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
6101 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
6102 // instead of computing a divide.
6103 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
6104
6105 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
6106 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
6107 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
6108 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
6109 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
6110
6111 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006112 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006113
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006114 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
6115 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
6116 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
6117 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
6118 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
6119 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
6120 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
6121 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
6122 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
6123
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006124 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006125 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006126 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006127 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6128 if (!HiOverflow)
6129 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006130 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006131 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006132 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006133 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
6134 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006135 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006136 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
6137 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6138 if (!HiOverflow)
6139 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006140 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006141 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006142 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006143 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
6144 if (!LoOverflow) {
6145 ConstantInt* DivNeg = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
6146 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivNeg,
6147 true) ? -1 : 0;
6148 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006149 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006150 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006151 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006152 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006153 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
6154 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006155 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
6156 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
6157 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
6158 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006159 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006160 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006161 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006162 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006163 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006164 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivRHS, true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006165 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006166 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
6167 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
Dan Gohman7f85fbd2008-09-11 00:25:00 +00006168 if (!HiOverflow)
6169 HiOverflow = SubWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006170 }
6171
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006172 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
6173 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006174 }
6175
6176 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006177 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006178 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
6179 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
6180 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
6181 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6182 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006183 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006184 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
6185 else if (LoOverflow)
6186 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
6187 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
6188 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006189 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006190 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
6191 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
6192 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6193 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006194 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006195 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
6196 else if (LoOverflow)
6197 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
6198 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6199 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006200 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006201 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
6202 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006203 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
6204 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6205 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006206 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006207 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006208 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
6209 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006210 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006211 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006212 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
6213 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6214 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006215 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6216 else
6217 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
6218 }
6219}
6220
6221
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006222/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
6223///
6224Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
6225 Instruction *LHSI,
6226 ConstantInt *RHS) {
6227 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
6228
6229 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00006230 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006231 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6232 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
6233 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006234 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
6235 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006236 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
6237
6238 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
6239 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
6240 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
6241 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
6242 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
6243 return &ICI;
6244 }
6245
6246 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
6247 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
6248
6249 // If so, the new one isn't.
6250 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
6251
6252 if (isTrueIfPositive)
6253 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
6254 else
6255 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
6256 }
6257 }
6258 break;
6259 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
6260 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
6261 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
6262 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6263
6264 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
6265 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
6266 // produced, eliminating a cast.
6267 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
6268 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
6269 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
6270 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
6271 // bit would not work.
6272 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00006273 (ICI.isEquality() ||
6274 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006275 uint32_t BitWidth =
6276 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
6277 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
6278 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
6279 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
6280 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
6281 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006282 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006283 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
6284 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6285 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
6286 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
6287 }
6288 }
6289
6290 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
6291 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
6292 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
6293 // access.
6294 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
6295 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
6296 Shift = 0;
6297
6298 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
6299 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
6300 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
6301 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
6302
6303 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
6304 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
6305 // rights, as they sign-extend.
6306 if (ShAmt) {
6307 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
6308 if (!CanFold) {
6309 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
6310 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
6311 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6312 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
6313
6314 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6315 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
6316 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
6317 CanFold = true;
6318 }
6319
6320 if (CanFold) {
6321 Constant *NewCst;
6322 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6323 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
6324 else
6325 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
6326
6327 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
6328 // compared.
6329 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
6330 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
6331 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
6332 // result is always true or false now.
6333 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6334 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6335 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
6336 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6337 } else {
6338 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
6339 Constant *NewAndCST;
6340 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6341 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
6342 else
6343 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
6344 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
6345 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
6346 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
6347 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
6348 return &ICI;
6349 }
6350 }
6351 }
6352
6353 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
6354 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
6355 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
6356 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
6357 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
6358 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
6359 // Compute C << Y.
6360 Value *NS;
6361 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006362 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006363 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6364 } else {
6365 // Insert a logical shift.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006366 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006367 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6368 }
6369 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
6370
6371 // Compute X & (C << Y).
6372 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006373 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006374 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6375
6376 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
6377 return &ICI;
6378 }
6379 }
6380 break;
6381
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006382 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
6383 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6384 if (!ShAmt) break;
6385
6386 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6387
6388 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6389 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6390 // simplified.
6391 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6392 break;
6393
6394 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6395 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6396 // comparison cannot succeed.
6397 Constant *Comp =
6398 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
6399 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6400 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6401 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6402 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6403 }
6404
6405 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6406 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6407 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6408 Constant *Mask =
6409 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006410
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006411 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006412 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006413 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6414 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6415 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6416 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006417 }
6418 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006419
6420 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
6421 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
6422 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6423 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
6424 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
6425 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
6426 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
6427 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006428 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006429 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6430 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6431
6432 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
6433 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
6434 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006435 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006436 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006437
6438 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006439 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006440 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006441 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006442 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006443
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006444 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6445 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6446 // simplified.
6447 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6448 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6449 break;
6450
6451 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006452
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006453 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6454 // comparison cannot succeed.
6455 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
6456 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
6457 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
6458 else
6459 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
6460
6461 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6462 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6463 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6464 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6465 }
6466
6467 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
6468 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
6469 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006470 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6471 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006472 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
6473 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
6474 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
6475 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006476
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006477 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006478 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6479 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
6480 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006481
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006482 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006483 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006484 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6485 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6486 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6487 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006488 }
6489 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006490 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006491
6492 case Instruction::SDiv:
6493 case Instruction::UDiv:
6494 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
6495 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
6496 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
6497 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
6498 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
6499 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006500 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6501 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6502 DivRHS))
6503 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006504 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006505
6506 case Instruction::Add:
6507 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
6508
6509 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
6510 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6511 if (!LHSC) break;
6512 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
6513
6514 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
6515 .subtract(LHSV);
6516
6517 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
6518 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
6519 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6520 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6521 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
6522 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6523 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6524 }
6525 } else {
6526 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
6527 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6528 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6529 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
6530 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6531 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6532 }
6533 }
6534 }
6535 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006536 }
6537
6538 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
6539 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6540 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6541
6542 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
6543 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
6544 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
6545 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
6546 case Instruction::SRem:
6547 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
6548 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
6549 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
6550 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
6551 Instruction *NewRem =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006552 BinaryOperator::CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006553 BO->getName());
6554 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
6555 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
6556 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
6557 }
6558 }
6559 break;
6560 case Instruction::Add:
6561 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
6562 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6563 if (BO->hasOneUse())
6564 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6565 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
6566 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
6567 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
6568 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
6569 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
6570
6571 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
6572 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
6573 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
6574 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
6575 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006576 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006577 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
6578 Neg->takeName(BO);
6579 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
6580 }
6581 }
6582 break;
6583 case Instruction::Xor:
6584 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
6585 // the explicit xor.
6586 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
6587 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6588 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
6589
6590 // FALLTHROUGH
6591 case Instruction::Sub:
6592 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
6593 if (RHSV == 0)
6594 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6595 BO->getOperand(1));
6596 break;
6597
6598 case Instruction::Or:
6599 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
6600 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
6601 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6602 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
6603 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
6604 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6605 isICMP_NE));
6606 }
6607 break;
6608
6609 case Instruction::And:
6610 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6611 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
6612 // comparison can never succeed!
6613 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
6614 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6615 isICMP_NE));
6616
6617 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
6618 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
6619 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
6620 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
6621 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
6622
6623 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00006624 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006625 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6626 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
6627 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6628 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
6629 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
6630 }
6631
6632 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
6633 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
6634 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6635 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
6636 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6637 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
6638 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
6639 }
6640 }
6641 default: break;
6642 }
6643 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
6644 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
6645 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
6646 AddToWorkList(II);
6647 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
6648 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
6649 return &ICI;
6650 }
6651 }
6652 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006653 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
6654 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006655 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
6656 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
6657 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
6658 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6659 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
6660 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
6661 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
6662 // smaller constant values.
6663 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
6664 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
6665 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
6666 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
6667 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
6668 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
6669 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
6670 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
6671 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
6672 }
6673 }
6674 }
6675 }
6676 return 0;
6677}
6678
6679/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
6680/// We only handle extending casts so far.
6681///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006682Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
6683 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006684 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
6685 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006686 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006687 Value *RHSCIOp;
6688
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006689 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
6690 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
6691 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
6692 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
6693 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
6694 Value *RHSOp = 0;
6695 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00006696 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006697 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
6698 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
6699 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
6700 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006701 RHSOp = InsertBitCastBefore(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006702 }
6703
6704 if (RHSOp)
6705 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
6706 }
6707
6708 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
6709 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006710 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
6711 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00006712 return 0;
6713
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006714 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
6715 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006716
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006717 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006718 // Not an extension from the same type?
6719 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006720 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
6721 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006722
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006723 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006724 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
6725 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
6726 return 0;
6727
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006728 // Deal with equality cases early.
6729 if (ICI.isEquality())
6730 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6731
6732 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
6733 // signed comparison.
6734 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
6735 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6736
6737 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
6738 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00006739 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006740
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006741 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
6742 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6743 if (!CI)
6744 return 0;
6745
6746 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
6747 // reextended to DestTy.
6748 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
6749 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
6750
6751 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
6752 if (Res2 == CI) {
6753 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
6754 // For example, we might have:
6755 // %A = sext short %X to uint
6756 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
6757 // It is incorrect to transform this into
6758 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
6759 // because %A may have negative value.
6760 //
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006761 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
6762 // signless.
6763 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006764 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006765 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006766 }
6767
6768 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
6769 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
6770
6771 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
6772 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
6773 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006774 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006775 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006776 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006777
6778 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
6779 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
6780 Value *Result;
6781 if (isSignedCmp) {
6782 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00006783 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006784 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006785 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006786 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006787 } else {
6788 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
6789 if (isSignedExt) {
6790 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
6791 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006792 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006793 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
6794 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
6795 } else {
6796 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006797 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006798 }
6799 }
6800
6801 // Finally, return the value computed.
6802 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006803 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006804 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006805
6806 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
6807 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
6808 "ICmp should be folded!");
6809 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
6810 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
6811 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006812}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006813
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006814Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
6815 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6816}
6817
6818Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
6819 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6820}
6821
6822Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006823 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
6824 return R;
6825
6826 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
6827
6828 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
6829 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
6830 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
6831 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
6832
6833 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Nate Begeman5bc1ea02008-07-29 15:49:41 +00006834 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType()) &&
6835 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006836 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006837 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006838
6839 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006840}
6841
6842Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
6843 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006844 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006845
6846 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
6847 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006848 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00006849 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
6850 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006851
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006852 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
6853 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00006854 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006855 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006856 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
6857 }
6858 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006859 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
6860 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
6861 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006862 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006863 }
6864
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006865 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6866 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
6867 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006868 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006869 return R;
6870
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006871 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006872 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
6873 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006874 return 0;
6875}
6876
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006877Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006878 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006879 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006880
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006881 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
6882 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006883 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6884 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
6885 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006886 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6887 return &I;
6888
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006889 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
6890 // of a signed value.
6891 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006892 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006893 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006894 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
6895 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006896 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006897 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00006898 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006899 }
6900
6901 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
6902 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
6903 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
6904 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006905 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006906 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
6907
6908 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6909 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
6910 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
6911 return R;
6912 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
6913 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
6914 return NV;
6915
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006916 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
6917 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
6918 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
6919 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
6920 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
6921 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
6922 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
6923 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
6924 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
6925 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
6926 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
6927 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006928 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006929 I.getName());
6930 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
6931
6932 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
6933 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
6934 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
6935 // other xforms later if dead.
6936 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6937 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6938 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
6939
6940 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
6941 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
6942 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
6943 // mask as appropriate.
6944 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6945 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
6946 else {
6947 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
6948 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
6949 }
6950
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006951 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(MaskV),
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006952 TI->getName());
6953 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
6954
6955 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
6956 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
6957 }
6958 }
6959
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006960 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006961 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6962 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
6963 Value *V1, *V2;
6964 ConstantInt *CC;
6965 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006966 default: break;
6967 case Instruction::Add:
6968 case Instruction::And:
6969 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006970 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006971 // These operators commute.
6972 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006973 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
6974 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006975 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006976 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006977 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006978 Op0BO->getName());
6979 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006980 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006981 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006982 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006983 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006984 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006985 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006986 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006987 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006988
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006989 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006990 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006991 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006992 match(Op0BOOp1,
6993 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006994 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6995 V2 == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006996 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006997 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
6998 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006999 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
7000 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007001 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007002 V1->getName()+".mask");
7003 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
7004
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007005 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007006 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007007 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007008
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007009 // FALL THROUGH.
7010 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007011 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007012 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7013 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007014 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007015 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007016 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
7017 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007018 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007019 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007020 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007021 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007022 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007023 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007024 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007025 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007026 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007027
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00007028 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007029 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7030 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
7031 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007032 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007033 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
7034 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007035 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007036 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
7037 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007038 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
7039 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007040 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007041 V1->getName()+".mask");
7042 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
7043
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007044 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007045 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007046
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007047 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007048 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007049 }
7050
7051
7052 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
7053 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
7054 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
7055 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
7056 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
7057
7058 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007059 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00007060 case Instruction::Add:
7061 isValid = isLeftShift;
7062 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007063 case Instruction::Or:
7064 case Instruction::Xor:
7065 highBitSet = false;
7066 break;
7067 case Instruction::And:
7068 highBitSet = true;
7069 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007070 }
7071
7072 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
7073 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
7074 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
7075 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
7076 // operation.
7077 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00007078 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007079 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007080
7081 if (isValid) {
7082 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
7083
7084 Instruction *NewShift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007085 BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007086 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007087 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007088
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007089 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007090 NewRHS);
7091 }
7092 }
7093 }
7094 }
7095
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007096 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007097 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
7098 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
7099 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007100
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007101 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007102 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007103 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
7104 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007105 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
7106 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
7107 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007108
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007109 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00007110 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
7111 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007112
7113 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
7114
7115 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00007116 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007117 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007118 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
7119 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
7120 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
7121 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007122 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007123 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
7124 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7125 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
7126 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007127 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007128 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7129
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007130 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007131 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007132 }
7133
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007134 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
7135 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
7136 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
7137 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
7138 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007139 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007140 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007141 }
7142 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
7143 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00007144 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007145 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007146 }
7147 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
7148 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
7149 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
7150 // generators.
7151 const Type *SExtType = 0;
7152 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007153 case 1 :
7154 case 8 :
7155 case 16 :
7156 case 32 :
7157 case 64 :
7158 case 128:
7159 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
7160 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007161 default: break;
7162 }
7163 if (SExtType) {
7164 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
7165 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
7166 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
7167 }
7168 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
7169 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007170 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007171
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007172 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007173 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7174 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7175 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007176 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007177 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007178 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7179
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007180 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007181 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007182 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007183
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007184 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007185 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7186 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7187 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007188 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007189 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007190
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00007191 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007192 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007193 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007194
7195 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
7196 } else {
7197 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007198 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007199
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007200 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007201 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7202 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7203 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
7204 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007205 BinaryOperator::Create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007206 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
7207 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7208
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007209 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007210 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007211 }
7212
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007213 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007214 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7215 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7216 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007217 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007218 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7219
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00007220 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007221 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007222 }
7223
7224 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007225 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007226 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007227 return 0;
7228}
7229
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007230
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007231/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
7232/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
7233/// X*Scale+Offset.
7234///
7235static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007236 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007237 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007238 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007239 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007240 Scale = 0;
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007241 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007242 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
7243 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
7244 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7245 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
7246 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
7247 Offset = 0;
7248 return I->getOperand(0);
7249 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
7250 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
7251 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
7252 Offset = 0;
7253 return I->getOperand(0);
7254 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7255 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
7256 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
7257 unsigned SubScale;
7258 Value *SubVal =
7259 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
7260 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
7261 Scale = SubScale;
7262 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007263 }
7264 }
7265 }
7266
7267 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
7268 Scale = 1;
7269 Offset = 0;
7270 return Val;
7271}
7272
7273
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007274/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
7275/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007276Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007277 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007278 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007279
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007280 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
7281 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00007282
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007283 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
7284 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
7285 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
7286 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
7287 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
7288
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007289 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00007290 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00007291 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007292 }
7293 }
7294
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007295 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
7296 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
7297 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
7298 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007299
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007300 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
7301 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007302 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7303
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007304 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
7305 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
7306 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
7307 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7308
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007309 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(AllocElTy);
7310 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007311 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007312
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007313 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
7314 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007315 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
7316 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007317 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
7318 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
7319
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007320 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
7321 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007322 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
7323 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007324
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007325 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
7326 Value *Amt = 0;
7327 if (Scale == 1) {
7328 Amt = NumElements;
7329 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007330 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007331 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
7332 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00007333 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007334 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007335 else if (Scale != 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007336 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007337 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007338 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007339 }
7340
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007341 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
7342 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007343 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007344 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
7345 }
7346
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007347 AllocationInst *New;
7348 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007349 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007350 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007351 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007352 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007353 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007354
7355 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
7356 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
7357 // die soon.
7358 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
7359 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007360 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
7361 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
7362 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007363 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
7364 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
7365 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007366 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
7367}
7368
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007369/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007370/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
7371/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
7372/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
7373/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
7374///
7375/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
7376/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007377///
7378/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
7379/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
7380/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
7381/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
7382/// efficiently truncated.
7383///
7384/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
7385/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
7386/// the final result.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00007387bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
7388 unsigned CastOpc,
7389 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007390 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
7391 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
7392 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007393
7394 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007395 if (!I) return false;
7396
7397 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007398
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007399 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
7400 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
7401 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
7402 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
7403 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
7404 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
7405 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
7406 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007407 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007408 ++NumCastsRemoved;
7409 return true;
7410 }
7411 }
7412
7413 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
7414 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
7415 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
7416
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007417 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007418 case Instruction::Add:
7419 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007420 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007421 case Instruction::And:
7422 case Instruction::Or:
7423 case Instruction::Xor:
7424 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007425 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7426 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7427 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
7428 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007429
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007430 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007431 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
7432 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
7433 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007434 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7435 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
7436 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007437 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7438 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007439 }
7440 break;
7441 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007442 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
7443 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
7444 // already zeros.
7445 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007446 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
7447 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7448 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007449 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007450 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
7451 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007452 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7453 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007454 }
7455 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007456 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007457 case Instruction::ZExt:
7458 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007459 case Instruction::Trunc:
7460 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00007461 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
7462 // of casts in the input.
7463 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007464 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007465 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007466 case Instruction::Select: {
7467 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
7468 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7469 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7470 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7471 NumCastsRemoved);
7472 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007473 case Instruction::PHI: {
7474 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
7475 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7476 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
7477 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
7478 NumCastsRemoved))
7479 return false;
7480 return true;
7481 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007482 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007483 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7484 break;
7485 }
7486
7487 return false;
7488}
7489
7490/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
7491/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
7492/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007493Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007494 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007495 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007496 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007497
7498 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7499 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00007500 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007501 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007502 case Instruction::Add:
7503 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00007504 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007505 case Instruction::And:
7506 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007507 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007508 case Instruction::AShr:
7509 case Instruction::LShr:
7510 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007511 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007512 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007513 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007514 LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007515 break;
7516 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007517 case Instruction::Trunc:
7518 case Instruction::ZExt:
7519 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007520 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007521 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
7522 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007523 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
7524 return I->getOperand(0);
7525
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007526 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007527 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007528 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007529 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007530 case Instruction::Select: {
7531 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
7532 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
7533 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
7534 break;
7535 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007536 case Instruction::PHI: {
7537 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7538 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
7539 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7540 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
7541 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
7542 }
7543 Res = NPN;
7544 break;
7545 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007546 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007547 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7548 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
7549 break;
7550 }
7551
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007552 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007553 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
7554}
7555
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007556/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
7557Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00007558 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7559
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00007560 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007561 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007562 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007563 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
7564 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
7565 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
7566 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007567 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00007568 }
7569 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00007570
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007571 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007572 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
7573 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
7574 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007575
7576 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007577 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
7578 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
7579 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007580
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007581 return 0;
7582}
7583
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007584/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
7585Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7586 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7587
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007588 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007589 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
7590 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007591 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
7592 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
7593 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
7594 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007595 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007596 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
7597 return &CI;
7598 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007599
7600 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
7601 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
7602 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
7603 // non-type-safe code.
7604 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
7605 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
7606 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
7607 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
7608 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
7609
7610 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
7611 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
7612 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
7613 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
7614 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
7615 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
7616
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007617 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
7618 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
7619 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007620 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007621 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007622 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getABITypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007623 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
7624 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007625
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007626 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
7627 if (Offset < 0) {
7628 --FirstIdx;
7629 Offset += TySize;
7630 assert(Offset >= 0);
7631 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007632 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007633 }
7634
7635 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007636
7637 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
7638 while (Offset) {
7639 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7640 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007641 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
7642 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
7643 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007644
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007645 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
7646 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
7647 } else {
7648 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7649 Offset = 0;
7650 OrigBase = 0;
7651 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007652 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7653 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007654 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getABITypeSize(STy->getElementType())){
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007655 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
7656 Offset %= EltSize;
7657 } else {
7658 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
7659 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007660 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
7661 } else {
7662 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7663 Offset = 0;
7664 OrigBase = 0;
7665 }
7666 }
7667 if (OrigBase) {
7668 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
7669 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
7670 // two.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007671 Instruction *NGEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(OrigBase,
7672 NewIndices.begin(),
7673 NewIndices.end(), "");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007674 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
7675 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
7676
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007677 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
7678 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7679 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
7680 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7681 }
7682 }
7683 }
7684 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007685 }
7686
7687 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7688}
7689
7690
7691
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007692/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
7693/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007694/// cases.
7695/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
7696Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7697 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7698 return Result;
7699
7700 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7701 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7702 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007703 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7704 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007705
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007706 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
7707 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007708 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
7709 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007710 KnownZero, KnownOne))
7711 return &CI;
7712
7713 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
7714 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007715 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
7716 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007717 return 0;
7718
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007719 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007720 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007721 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
7722 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007723 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007724 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007725 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
7726 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
7727 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
7728 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007729 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007730 bool DoXForm;
7731 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7732 default:
7733 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
7734 // get here because of the check above.
7735 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
7736 case Instruction::Trunc:
7737 DoXForm = true;
7738 break;
7739 case Instruction::ZExt:
7740 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
7741 break;
7742 case Instruction::SExt:
7743 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
7744 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007745 }
7746
7747 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007748 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
7749 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007750 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
7751 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7752 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
7753 case Instruction::Trunc:
7754 case Instruction::BitCast:
7755 // Just replace this cast with the result.
7756 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7757 case Instruction::ZExt: {
7758 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
7759 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00007760 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
7761 SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007762 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007763 }
7764 case Instruction::SExt:
7765 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007766 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007767 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
7768 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007769 }
7770 }
7771 }
7772
7773 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
7774 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
7775
7776 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7777 case Instruction::Add:
7778 case Instruction::Mul:
7779 case Instruction::And:
7780 case Instruction::Or:
7781 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007782 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007783 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
7784 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7785 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7786 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
7787 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007788 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
7789 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00007790 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007791 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7792 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007793 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007794 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007795 }
7796 }
7797
7798 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
7799 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
7800 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007801 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007802 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007803 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007804 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007805 }
7806 break;
7807 case Instruction::SDiv:
7808 case Instruction::UDiv:
7809 case Instruction::SRem:
7810 case Instruction::URem:
7811 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
7812 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
7813 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7814 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7815 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007816 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
7817 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007818 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7819 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7820 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7821 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007822 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007823 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
7824 }
7825 }
7826 break;
7827
7828 case Instruction::Shl:
7829 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
7830 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
7831 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
7832 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
7833 // in the value.
7834 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
7835 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007836 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
7837 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
7838 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007839 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007840 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007841 }
7842 break;
7843 case Instruction::AShr:
7844 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
7845 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
7846 // simplifications.
7847 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
7848 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007849 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007850 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
7851 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007852 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007853 }
7854 }
7855 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007856 }
7857 return 0;
7858}
7859
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007860Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007861 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7862 return Result;
7863
7864 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7865 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007866 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7867 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007868
7869 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
7870 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7871 default: break;
7872 case Instruction::LShr:
7873 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
7874 // are already zeros.
7875 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007876 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007877
7878 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007879 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007880 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
7881 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007882 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
7883 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
7884
7885 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
7886 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007887 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
7888 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
7889 Ty, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007890 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007891 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007892 } else { // This is a variable shr.
7893
7894 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
7895 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
7896 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007897 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007898 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
7899
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007900 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007901 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007902 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007903 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V,
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007904 SrcI->getOperand(0),
7905 "tmp"), CI);
7906 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007907 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007908 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007909 }
7910 break;
7911 }
7912 }
7913
7914 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007915}
7916
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007917/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
7918/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
7919Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
7920 bool DoXform) {
7921 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7922 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7923 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7924 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7925 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7926
7927 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
7928 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
7929 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7930 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
7931 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7932
7933 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7934 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7935 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007936 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In, Sh,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007937 In->getName()+".lobit"),
7938 CI);
7939 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007940 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007941 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7942
7943 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
7944 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007945 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007946 In->getName()+".not"),
7947 CI);
7948 }
7949
7950 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7951 }
7952
7953
7954
7955 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7956 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7957 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7958 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7959 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7960 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7961 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7962 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7963 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
7964 // This only works for EQ and NE
7965 ICI->isEquality()) {
7966 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
7967 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
7968 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
7969 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
7970 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
7971
7972 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
7973 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
7974 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7975
7976 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7977 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
7978 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
7979 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
7980 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
7981 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
7982 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7983 }
7984
7985 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
7986 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7987 if (ShiftAmt) {
7988 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
7989 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007990 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007991 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
7992 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
7993 }
7994
7995 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
7996 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007997 In = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007998 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
7999 }
8000
8001 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
8002 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
8003 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008004 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008005 }
8006 }
8007 }
8008
8009 return 0;
8010}
8011
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008012Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008013 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
8014 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8015 return Result;
8016
8017 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8018
8019 // If this is a cast of a cast
8020 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008021 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
8022 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
8023 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
8024 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
8025 // Get the sizes of the types involved
8026 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008027 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8028 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8029 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008030 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
8031 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
8032 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00008033 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00008034 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008035 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008036 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008037 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
8038 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
8039 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
8040 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008041 And = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008042 }
8043 return And;
8044 }
8045 }
8046 }
8047
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008048 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
8049 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00008050
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008051 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
8052 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
8053 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
8054 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
8055 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
8056 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
8057 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
8058 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
8059 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
8060 Value *LCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, LHS, CI.getType(), CI);
8061 Value *RCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, RHS, CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008062 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00008063 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008064 }
8065
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008066 return 0;
8067}
8068
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008069Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008070 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8071 return I;
8072
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008073 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8074
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008075 // Canonicalize sign-extend from i1 to a select.
8076 if (Src->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
8077 return SelectInst::Create(Src,
8078 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(CI.getType()),
8079 Constant::getNullValue(CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008080
8081 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
8082 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
8083 if (getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
8084 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
8085 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>(Op->getType())->getBitWidth();
8086 unsigned MidBits = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
8087 unsigned DestBits = cast<IntegerType>(CI.getType())->getBitWidth();
8088 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
8089
8090 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
8091 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
8092 // bits, it is already ready.
8093 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
8094 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
8095 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
8096 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
8097 // bits, just sext from i32.
8098 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8099 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8100 } else {
8101 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
8102 // bits, just truncate to i32.
8103 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8104 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8105 }
8106 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008107
8108 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
8109 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
8110 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
8111 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
8112 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
8113 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
8114 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
8115 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
8116 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
8117 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
8118 // into:
8119 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
8120 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
8121 Value *A = 0;
8122 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
8123 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
8124 m_ConstantInt(CA))) &&
8125 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
8126 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
8127 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8128 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8129 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8130 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
8131 Constant *ShAmtV = ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
8132 I = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I, ShAmtV,
8133 CI.getName()), CI);
8134 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
8135 }
8136 }
8137
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008138 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008139}
8140
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008141/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
8142/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008143static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem) {
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008144 bool losesInfo;
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008145 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008146 (void)F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &losesInfo);
8147 if (!losesInfo)
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008148 return ConstantFP::get(F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008149 return 0;
8150}
8151
8152/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
8153/// through it until we get the source value.
8154static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V) {
8155 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
8156 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
8157 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0));
8158
8159 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
8160 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
8161 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
8162 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
8163 if (CFP->getType() == Type::PPC_FP128Ty)
8164 return V; // No constant folding of this.
8165 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008166 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008167 return V;
8168 if (CFP->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
8169 return V; // Won't shrink.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008170 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008171 return V;
8172 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
8173 }
8174
8175 return V;
8176}
8177
8178Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
8179 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8180 return I;
8181
8182 // If we have fptrunc(add (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
8183 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
8184 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to add/sub/mul/div as well as
8185 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
8186 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
8187 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
8188 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
8189 default: break;
8190 case Instruction::Add:
8191 case Instruction::Sub:
8192 case Instruction::Mul:
8193 case Instruction::FDiv:
8194 case Instruction::FRem:
8195 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
8196 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0));
8197 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1));
8198 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
8199 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
8200 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8201 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
8202 // the cast, do this xform.
8203 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
8204 RHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
8205 LHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, LHSTrunc,
8206 CI.getType(), CI);
8207 RHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, RHSTrunc,
8208 CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008209 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008210 }
8211 }
8212 break;
8213 }
8214 }
8215 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008216}
8217
8218Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
8219 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8220}
8221
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008222Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008223 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8224 if (OpI == 0)
8225 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8226
8227 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
8228 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
8229 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8230 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8231 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8232 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8233 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8234 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
8235 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
8236 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8237 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008238
8239 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008240}
8241
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008242Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008243 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8244 if (OpI == 0)
8245 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8246
8247 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
8248 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
8249 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8250 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8251 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8252 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8253 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8254 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
8255 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <=
8256 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8257 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008258
8259 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008260}
8261
8262Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8263 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8264}
8265
8266Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8267 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8268}
8269
8270Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008271 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008272}
8273
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008274Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
8275 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8276 return I;
8277
8278 const Type *DestPointee = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType())->getElementType();
8279 if (!DestPointee->isSized()) return 0;
8280
8281 // If this is inttoptr(add (ptrtoint x), cst), try to turn this into a GEP.
8282 ConstantInt *Cst;
8283 Value *X;
8284 if (match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Cast<PtrToIntInst>(m_Value(X)),
8285 m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8286 // If the source and destination operands have the same type, see if this
8287 // is a single-index GEP.
8288 if (X->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8289 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Bill Wendlingb9d4f8d2008-03-14 05:12:19 +00008290 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008291
8292 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8293 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8294 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8295
8296 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8297 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8298 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008299 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, ConstantInt::get(Offset));
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008300 }
8301 }
8302 // TODO: Could handle other cases, e.g. where add is indexing into field of
8303 // struct etc.
8304 } else if (CI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
8305 match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8306 // Otherwise, if this is inttoptr(add x, cst), try to turn this into an
8307 // "inttoptr+GEP" instead of "add+intptr".
8308
8309 // Get the size of the pointee type.
8310 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
8311
8312 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8313 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8314 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8315
8316 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8317 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8318 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
8319
8320 Instruction *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new IntToPtrInst(X, CI.getType(),
8321 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008322 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(P, ConstantInt::get(Offset), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008323 }
8324 }
8325 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008326}
8327
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008328Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008329 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
8330 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
8331 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8332 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8333 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
8334
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008335 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008336 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8337 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008338 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
8339 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
8340 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008341 } else {
8342 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8343 return Result;
8344 }
8345
8346
8347 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
8348 // be replaced by the operand.
8349 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
8350 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
8351
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008352 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008353 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
8354 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
8355 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
8356
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00008357 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
8358 // required for changing types.
8359 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
8360 return 0;
8361
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008362 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
8363 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
8364 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
8365 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
8366 return V;
8367
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00008368 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
8369 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008370 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
8371 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8372 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
8373 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
8374 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
8375 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
8376 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
8377 ++NumZeros;
8378 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008379
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008380 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
8381 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
8382 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008383 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
8384 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008385 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008386 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00008387
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008388 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
8389 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
8390 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
8391 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008392 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
8393 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008394 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
8395 CastInst *Tmp;
8396 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
8397 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
8398 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
8399 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
8400 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
8401 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
8402 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008403 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8404 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
8405 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8406 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008407 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
8408 // know the vector types match #elts.
8409 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00008410 }
8411 }
8412 }
8413 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00008414 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008415}
8416
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008417/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
8418/// %C = or %A, %B
8419/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
8420/// into:
8421/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
8422/// %D = or %A, %C
8423///
8424/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
8425/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
8426/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
8427///
8428static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
8429 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8430 case Instruction::Add:
8431 case Instruction::Mul:
8432 case Instruction::And:
8433 case Instruction::Or:
8434 case Instruction::Xor:
8435 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
8436 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
8437 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008438 case Instruction::LShr:
8439 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008440 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008441 default:
8442 return 0; // Cannot fold
8443 }
8444}
8445
8446/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
8447/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
8448static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
8449 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8450 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
8451 case Instruction::Add:
8452 case Instruction::Sub:
8453 case Instruction::Or:
8454 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008455 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008456 case Instruction::LShr:
8457 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008458 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008459 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00008460 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008461 case Instruction::Mul:
8462 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
8463 }
8464}
8465
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008466/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
8467/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
8468Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
8469 Instruction *FI) {
8470 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
8471 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
8472 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008473 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008474 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
8475 return 0;
8476 } else {
8477 return 0; // unknown unary op.
8478 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008479
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008480 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008481 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
8482 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008483 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008484 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008485 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008486 }
8487
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008488 // Only handle binary operators here.
8489 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008490 return 0;
8491
8492 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
8493 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
8494 bool MatchIsOpZero;
8495 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8496 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8497 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8498 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8499 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8500 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8501 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8502 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8503 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8504 MatchIsOpZero = false;
8505 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
8506 return 0;
8507 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8508 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8509 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8510 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8511 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8512 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8513 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8514 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8515 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8516 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8517 } else {
8518 return 0;
8519 }
8520
8521 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008522 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
8523 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008524 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
8525
8526 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
8527 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008528 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008529 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008530 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008531 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00008532 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
8533 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008534}
8535
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008536/// visitSelectInstWithICmp - Visit a SelectInst that has an
8537/// ICmpInst as its first operand.
8538///
8539Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI,
8540 ICmpInst *ICI) {
8541 bool Changed = false;
8542 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
8543 Value *CmpLHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
8544 Value *CmpRHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
8545 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8546 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8547
8548 // Check cases where the comparison is with a constant that
8549 // can be adjusted to fit the min/max idiom. We may edit ICI in
8550 // place here, so make sure the select is the only user.
8551 if (ICI->hasOneUse())
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008552 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CmpRHS)) {
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008553 switch (Pred) {
8554 default: break;
8555 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
8556 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: {
8557 // X < MIN ? T : F --> F
8558 if (CI->isMinValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT))
8559 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8560 // X < C ? X : C-1 --> X > C-1 ? C-1 : X
8561 Constant *AdjustedRHS = SubOne(CI);
8562 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8563 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8564 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8565 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8566 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8567 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8568 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8569 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8570 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8571 Changed = true;
8572 }
8573 break;
8574 }
8575 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
8576 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: {
8577 // X > MAX ? T : F --> F
8578 if (CI->isMaxValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT))
8579 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8580 // X > C ? X : C+1 --> X < C+1 ? C+1 : X
8581 Constant *AdjustedRHS = AddOne(CI);
8582 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8583 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8584 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8585 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8586 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8587 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8588 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8589 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8590 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8591 Changed = true;
8592 }
8593 break;
8594 }
8595 }
8596
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008597 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
8598 // (x >s -1) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
8599 CmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
8600 if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt(0)) &&
8601 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt(-1)))
8602 Pred = CmpInst::getInversePredicate(Pred);
8603 else if (!match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt(-1)) ||
8604 !match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt(0)))
8605 Pred = CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
8606 if (Pred != CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE) {
8607 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
8608 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
8609 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
8610 const APInt &Op1CV = CI->getValue();
8611
8612 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
8613 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
8614 if ((Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
8615 (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
8616 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
8617 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
8618 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
8619 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
8620 In->getName()+".lobit"),
8621 *ICI);
Dan Gohman21440ac2008-11-02 00:17:33 +00008622 if (In->getType() != SI.getType())
8623 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, SI.getType(),
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008624 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", ICI);
8625
8626 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
8627 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
8628 In->getName()+".not"), *ICI);
8629
8630 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, In);
8631 }
8632 }
8633 }
8634
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008635 if (CmpLHS == TrueVal && CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
8636 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
8637 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8638 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8639 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
8640 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8641 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8642 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8643
8644 } else if (CmpLHS == FalseVal && CmpRHS == TrueVal) {
8645 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
8646 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8647 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8648 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
8649 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8650 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8651 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8652 }
8653
8654 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer ABS
8655
8656 return Changed ? &SI : 0;
8657}
8658
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008659Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008660 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
8661 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8662 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8663
8664 // select true, X, Y -> X
8665 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008666 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008667 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008668
8669 // select C, X, X -> X
8670 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
8671 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8672
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008673 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
8674 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8675 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
8676 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8677 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
8678 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8679 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8680 else
8681 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8682 }
8683
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008684 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008685 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008686 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008687 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008688 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008689 } else {
8690 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
8691 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008692 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008693 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008694 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008695 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008696 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008697 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008698 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008699 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008700 } else {
8701 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
8702 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008703 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008704 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008705 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008706 }
8707 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008708
8709 // select a, b, a -> a&b
8710 // select a, a, b -> a|b
8711 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008712 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008713 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008714 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008715 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008716
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008717 // Selecting between two integer constants?
8718 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
8719 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008720 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008721 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008722 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008723 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008724 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008725 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008726 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008727 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008728 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008729 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008730
8731 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008732
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008733 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008734
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008735 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008736 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008737 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008738 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008739 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008740 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008741 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008742 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008743 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008744 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, X,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008745 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008746 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
8747
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008748 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
8749 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
8750 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008751 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8752 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008753 if (SRASize < SISize)
8754 opc = Instruction::SExt;
8755 else if (SRASize > SISize)
8756 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008757 return CastInst::Create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008758 }
8759 }
8760
8761
8762 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008763 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008764 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
8765 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008766 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00008767 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008768 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
8769 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
8770 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008771 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
8772 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
8773 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008774 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
8775 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008776 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
8777 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008778 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008779 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008780 Value *V = ICA;
8781 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008782 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008783 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
8784 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
8785 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008786 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008787 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008788
8789 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008790 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8791 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008792 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008793 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8794 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8795 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8796 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8797 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8798 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8799 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8800 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8801 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008802 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008803 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008804 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008805 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008806 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008807 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008808
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008809 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008810 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008811 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8812 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8813 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8814 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8815 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8816 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8817 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8818 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8819 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
8820 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8821 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008822 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008823 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
8824 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008825 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008826 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008827 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect ABS
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008828 }
8829
8830 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008831 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal))
8832 if (Instruction *Result = visitSelectInstWithICmp(SI, ICI))
8833 return Result;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008834
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008835 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8836 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8837 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008838 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
8839
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008840 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
8841 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
8842 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
8843 return IV;
8844
8845 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
8846 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008847 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8848 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8849 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
8850 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8851 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8852 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
8853 }
8854
8855 if (AddOp) {
8856 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
8857 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
8858 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
8859 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
8860 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
8861 }
8862
8863 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008864 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
8865 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
8866 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
8867 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
8868 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
8869 } else {
8870 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008871 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008872 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008873
8874 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
8875 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
8876 if (AddOp != TI)
8877 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
8878 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008879 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
8880 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008881
8882 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008883 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008884 }
8885 }
8886 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008887
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008888 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008889 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008890 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
8891 // transformation we are doing here.
8892 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8893 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8894 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
8895 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
8896 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8897 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
8898 OpToFold = 1;
8899 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
8900 OpToFold = 2;
8901 }
8902
8903 if (OpToFold) {
8904 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008905 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008906 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(),
8907 TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008908 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008909 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008910 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008911 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008912 else {
8913 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
8914 }
8915 }
8916 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00008917
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008918 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8919 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8920 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8921 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
8922 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8923 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
8924 OpToFold = 1;
8925 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
8926 OpToFold = 2;
8927 }
8928
8929 if (OpToFold) {
8930 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008931 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008932 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C,
8933 FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008934 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008935 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008936 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008937 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008938 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008939 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008940 }
8941 }
8942 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00008943
8944 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
8945 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
8946 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
8947 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
8948 return &SI;
8949 }
8950
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008951 return 0;
8952}
8953
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008954/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
8955/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
8956/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
8957/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
8958/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
8959///
8960static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8961 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008962
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008963 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
8964 if (!U) return Align;
8965
8966 switch (getOpcode(U)) {
8967 default: break;
8968 case Instruction::BitCast:
8969 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
8970 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008971 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
8972 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00008973 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00008974 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
8975 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008976 AllZeroOperands = false;
8977 break;
8978 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008979
8980 if (AllZeroOperands) {
8981 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008982 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008983 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008984 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008985 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008986 }
8987
8988 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
8989 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
8990 // of the global.
8991 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
8992 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8993 Align = PrefAlign;
8994 }
8995 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
8996 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
8997 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
8998 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
8999 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
9000 Align = PrefAlign;
9001 }
9002 }
9003
9004 return Align;
9005}
9006
9007/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
9008/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
9009/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
9010/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
9011unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
9012 unsigned PrefAlign) {
9013 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
9014 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
9015 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
9016 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
9017 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
9018 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
9019 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
9020
9021 if (PrefAlign > Align)
9022 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
9023
9024 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
9025 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009026}
9027
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009028Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009029 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
9030 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009031 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
9032 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
9033
9034 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
9035 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, MinAlign));
9036 return MI;
9037 }
9038
9039 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
9040 // load/store.
9041 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
9042 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
9043
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009044 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
9045 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
9046 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
9047 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009048 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009049 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
9050
9051 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009052 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009053
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009054 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009055 Type *NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009056
9057 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
9058 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
9059 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
9060 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
9061 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
9062 // integer datatype.
9063 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
9064 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
9065 if (SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
9066 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
9067 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009068 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009069 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
9070 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
9071 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
9072 else
9073 break;
9074 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
9075 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
9076 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
9077 else
9078 break;
9079 } else
9080 break;
9081 }
9082
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009083 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009084 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
9085 }
9086 }
9087
9088
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009089 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
9090 // infer, use it.
9091 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
9092 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
9093
9094 Value *Src = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy, *MI);
9095 Value *Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy, *MI);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009096 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
9097 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
9098 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
9099
9100 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
9101 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
9102 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009103}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009104
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009105Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
9106 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
9107 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
9108 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
9109 return MI;
9110 }
9111
9112 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
9113 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
9114 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
9115 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::Int8Ty)
9116 return 0;
9117 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
9118 Alignment = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
9119
9120 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
9121 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
9122
9123 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
9124 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
9125 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
9126
9127 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
9128 Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy), *MI);
9129
9130 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
9131 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
9132
9133 // Extract the fill value and store.
9134 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
9135 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill), Dest, false,
9136 Alignment), *MI);
9137
9138 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
9139 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
9140 return MI;
9141 }
9142
9143 return 0;
9144}
9145
9146
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009147/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
9148/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
9149/// the heavy lifting.
9150///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009151Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009152 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
9153 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
9154
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009155 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
9156 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009157 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009158 bool Changed = false;
9159
9160 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
9161 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
9162 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9163
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009164 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009165 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009166 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
9167 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
9168 // alignment is sufficient.
9169 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009170 }
9171
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009172 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
9173 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
9174 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009175 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009176 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
9177 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
9178 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00009179 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID;
9180 if (CI.getOperand(3)->getType() == Type::Int32Ty)
9181 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i32;
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00009182 else
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00009183 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i64;
9184 CI.setOperand(0, Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009185 Changed = true;
9186 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00009187
9188 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
9189 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
9190 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009191 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009192
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009193 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
9194 // set, update the alignment.
9195 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009196 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
9197 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009198 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
9199 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
9200 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009201 }
9202
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009203 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009204 }
9205
9206 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
9207 default: break;
9208 case Intrinsic::bswap:
9209 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
9210 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
9211 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
9212 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
9213 break;
9214 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
9215 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
9216 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
9217 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
9218 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
9219 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9220 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9221 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9222 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),
9223 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()),
9224 CI);
9225 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009226 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009227 break;
9228 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
9229 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
9230 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9231 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
9232 const Type *OpPtrTy =
9233 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
9234 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy, CI);
9235 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
9236 }
9237 break;
9238 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
9239 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
9240 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009241 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9242 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9243 const Type *OpPtrTy =
9244 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
9245 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy, CI);
9246 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
9247 }
9248 break;
9249
9250 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
9251 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
9252 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
9253 uint64_t UndefElts;
9254 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
9255 UndefElts)) {
9256 II->setOperand(1, V);
9257 return II;
9258 }
9259 break;
9260 }
9261
9262 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
9263 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
9264 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
9265 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009266
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009267 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
9268 bool AllEltsOk = true;
9269 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
9270 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
9271 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
9272 AllEltsOk = false;
9273 break;
9274 }
9275 }
9276
9277 if (AllEltsOk) {
9278 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
9279 Value *Op0 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),Mask->getType(),CI);
9280 Value *Op1 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2),Mask->getType(),CI);
9281 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009282
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009283 // Only extract each element once.
9284 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
9285 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
9286
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009287 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009288 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
9289 continue;
9290 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
9291 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
9292
9293 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
9294 Instruction *Elt =
9295 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
9296 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
9297 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009298 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009299
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009300 // Insert this value into the result vector.
9301 Result = InsertElementInst::Create(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
9302 i, "tmp");
9303 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009304 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009305 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009306 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009307 }
9308 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009309
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009310 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
9311 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
9312 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
9313 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
9314 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
9315 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
9316 if (&*++BI == II)
9317 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009318 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009319 }
9320
9321 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
9322 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
9323 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
9324 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
9325 bool CannotRemove = false;
9326 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
9327 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI)) {
9328 CannotRemove = true;
9329 break;
9330 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +00009331 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
9332 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
9333 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
9334 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
9335 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9336 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
9337 } else {
9338 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
9339 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00009340 CannotRemove = true;
9341 break;
9342 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009343 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009344 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009345
9346 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
9347 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
9348 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
9349 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9350 break;
9351 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009352 }
9353
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009354 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009355}
9356
9357// InvokeInst simplification
9358//
9359Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009360 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009361}
9362
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +00009363/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
9364/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009365static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
9366 const CastInst * const CI,
9367 const TargetData * const TD,
9368 const int ix) {
9369 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
9370 return false;
9371
9372 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
9373 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
9374 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009375 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, Attribute::ByVal))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009376 return true;
9377
9378 const Type* SrcTy =
9379 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
9380 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
9381 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
9382 return false;
9383 if (TD->getABITypeSize(SrcTy) != TD->getABITypeSize(DstTy))
9384 return false;
9385 return true;
9386}
9387
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009388// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
9389//
9390Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009391 bool Changed = false;
9392
9393 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
9394 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009395 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
9396
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009397 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009398
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009399 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
9400 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
9401 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
9402 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
9403 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009404 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009405 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
9406 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009407 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
9408 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
9409 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
9410 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
9411 return 0;
9412 }
9413
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009414 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
9415 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
9416 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
9417 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009418 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009419 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009420 CS.getInstruction());
9421
9422 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
9423 CS.getInstruction()->
9424 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
9425
9426 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
9427 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009428 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9429 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009430 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009431 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
9432 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009433
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009434 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
9435 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
9436 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
9437 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
9438
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009439 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9440 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
9441 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +00009442 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009443 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
9444 // the call.
9445 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009446 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
9447 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
9448 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
9449 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
9450 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009451 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009452 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009453 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009454
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009455 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009456 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009457 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009458 Changed = true;
9459 }
9460
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009461 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009462}
9463
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009464// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
9465// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
9466//
9467bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
9468 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
9469 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009470 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
9471 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009472 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00009473 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009474 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009475 const AttrListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getAttributes();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009476
9477 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
9478 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
9479 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
9480 //
9481 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
9482 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009483 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009484
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009485 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +00009486 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
9487
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009488 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009489 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +00009490 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009491 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
9492 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
9493 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
Duncan Sands34b176a2008-06-17 15:55:30 +00009494 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType())))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009495 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009496
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009497 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009498 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009499 NewRetTy != Type::VoidTy && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009500 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
9501
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009502 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009503 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009504 if (RAttrs & Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +00009505 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
9506 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009507
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009508 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
9509 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
9510 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
9511 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
9512 if (!Caller->use_empty())
9513 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
9514 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
9515 UI != E; ++UI)
9516 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
9517 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00009518 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009519 return false;
9520 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009521
9522 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
9523 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009524
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009525 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
9526 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
9527 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00009528 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009529
9530 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009531 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
9532
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009533 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1)
9534 & Attribute::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009535 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009536
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009537 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
9538 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009539 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009540 ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) || ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
9541 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) || ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType()));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009542 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009543 }
9544
9545 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009546 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009547 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009548
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009549 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
9550 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009551 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009552 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
9553 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009554 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
9555 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009556 break;
Devang Pateleaf42ab2008-09-23 23:03:40 +00009557 Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009558 if (PAttrs & Attribute::VarArgsIncompatible)
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009559 return false;
9560 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009561
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009562 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
9563 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
9564 std::vector<Value*> Args;
9565 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009566 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009567 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
9568
9569 // Get any return attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009570 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009571
9572 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
9573 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009574 RAttrs &= ~Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009575
9576 // Add the new return attributes.
9577 if (RAttrs)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009578 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009579
9580 AI = CS.arg_begin();
9581 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9582 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
9583 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
9584 Args.push_back(*AI);
9585 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00009586 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009587 false, ParamTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009588 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009589 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009590 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009591
9592 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009593 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009594 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009595 }
9596
9597 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
9598 // now...
9599 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
9600 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
9601
9602 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009603 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009604 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00009605 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
9606 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009607 } else {
9608 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
9609 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9610 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
9611 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
9612 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009613 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
9614 PTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009615 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009616 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
9617 Args.push_back(Cast);
9618 } else {
9619 Args.push_back(*AI);
9620 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009621
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009622 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009623 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009624 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009625 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009626 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009627 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009628
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009629 if (Attributes FnAttrs = CallerPAL.getFnAttributes())
9630 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, FnAttrs));
9631
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009632 if (NewRetTy == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009633 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009634
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009635 const AttrListPtr &NewCallerPAL = AttrListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009636
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009637 Instruction *NC;
9638 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009639 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009640 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9641 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00009642 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009643 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009644 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009645 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9646 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009647 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
9648 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00009649 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009650 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009651 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009652 }
9653
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009654 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009655 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009656 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009657 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009658 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009659 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009660 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009661
9662 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
9663 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
9664 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +00009665 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009666 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
9667 } else {
9668 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
9669 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
9670 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009671 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009672 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00009673 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009674 }
9675 }
9676
9677 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9678 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00009679 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009680 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009681 return true;
9682}
9683
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009684// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
9685// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
9686//
9687Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
9688 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
9689 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9690 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009691 const AttrListPtr &Attrs = CS.getAttributes();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009692
9693 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
9694 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009695 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(Attribute::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009696 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009697
9698 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
9699 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
9700
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +00009701 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009702 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
9703 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
9704
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009705 const AttrListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getAttributes();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009706 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009707 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
9708 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009709 Attributes NestAttr = Attribute::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009710
9711 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
9712 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
9713 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009714 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, Attribute::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009715 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
9716 NestTy = *I;
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009717 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttributes(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009718 break;
9719 }
9720
9721 if (NestTy) {
9722 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
9723 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
9724 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
9725
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009726 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009727 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009728
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009729 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009730 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
9731
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009732 // Add any result attributes.
9733 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getRetAttributes())
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009734 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009735
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009736 {
9737 unsigned Idx = 1;
9738 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
9739 do {
9740 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009741 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009742 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
9743 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
9744 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
9745 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009746 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009747 }
9748
9749 if (I == E)
9750 break;
9751
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009752 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009753 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009754 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttributes(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009755 NewAttrs.push_back
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009756 (AttributeWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009757
9758 ++Idx, ++I;
9759 } while (1);
9760 }
9761
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009762 // Add any function attributes.
9763 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getFnAttributes())
9764 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, Attr));
9765
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009766 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
9767 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009768 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009769
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009770 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009771 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
9772
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009773 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009774 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009775 {
9776 unsigned Idx = 1;
9777 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
9778 E = FTy->param_end();
9779
9780 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009781 if (Idx == NestIdx)
9782 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009783 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009784
9785 if (I == E)
9786 break;
9787
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009788 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009789 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009790
9791 ++Idx, ++I;
9792 } while (1);
9793 }
9794
9795 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
9796 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9797 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009798 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg());
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009799 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
9800 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009801 const AttrListPtr &NewPAL = AttrListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009802
9803 Instruction *NewCaller;
9804 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009805 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
9806 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9807 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9808 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009809 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009810 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009811 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009812 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9813 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009814 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
9815 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
9816 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
9817 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009818 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009819 }
9820 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9821 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
9822 Caller->eraseFromParent();
9823 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
9824 return 0;
9825 }
9826 }
9827
9828 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
9829 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
9830 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9831 Constant *NewCallee =
9832 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
9833 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
9834 return CS.getInstruction();
9835}
9836
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009837/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
9838/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
9839/// and a single binop.
9840Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9841 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009842 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
9843 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009844 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009845 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9846 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
9847
9848 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
9849 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009850
9851 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
9852 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009853 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009854 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009855 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009856 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009857 // types or GEP's with different index types.
9858 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
9859 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009860 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009861
9862 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
9863 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
9864 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
9865 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
9866 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009867
9868 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
9869 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
9870 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009871 }
9872
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009873 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
9874
9875 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
9876 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
9877 // hide them behind a phi.
9878 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
9879 return 0;
9880
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009881 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009882 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009883 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009884 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009885 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
9886 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009887 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9888 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009889 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
9890 LHSVal = NewLHS;
9891 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009892
9893 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009894 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
9895 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009896 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9897 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009898 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
9899 RHSVal = NewRHS;
9900 }
9901
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009902 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
9903 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9904 if (NewLHS) {
9905 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9906 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9907 }
9908 if (NewRHS) {
9909 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
9910 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9911 }
9912 }
9913
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009914 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009915 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009916 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009917 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009918 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009919 else {
9920 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009921 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009922 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009923}
9924
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009925/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
9926/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
9927/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
9928/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009929///
9930/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
9931/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
9932/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009933static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
9934 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
9935
9936 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
9937 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
9938 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009939
9940 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
9941 // profitable to do this xform.
9942 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
9943 bool isAddressTaken = false;
9944 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
9945 UI != E; ++UI) {
9946 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
9947 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
9948 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
9949 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
9950 }
9951 isAddressTaken = true;
9952 break;
9953 }
9954
9955 if (!isAddressTaken)
9956 return false;
9957 }
9958
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009959 return true;
9960}
9961
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009962
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009963// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
9964// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
9965// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
9966Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9967 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
9968
9969 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
9970 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
9971 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
9972 // code size and simplifying code.
9973 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
9974 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009975 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009976 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
9977 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009978 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009979 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
9980 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009981 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009982 if (ConstantOp == 0)
9983 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009984 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
9985 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
9986 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
9987 // load and the PHI.
9988 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
9989 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9990 return 0;
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009991
9992 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9993 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9994 // the path through the other successor.
9995 if (isVolatile &&
9996 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9997 return 0;
9998
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009999 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +000010000 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010001 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
10002 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
10003 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010004 } else {
10005 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
10006 }
10007
10008 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
10009 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10010 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
10011 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010012 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010013 return 0;
10014 if (CastSrcTy) {
10015 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
10016 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010017 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010018 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
10019 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010020 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
10021 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
10022 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
10023 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010024
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010025 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10026 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10027 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010028 if (isVolatile &&
10029 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10030 return 0;
10031
10032
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010033 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
10034 return 0;
10035 }
10036 }
10037
10038 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
10039 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010040 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
10041 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +000010042 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010043
10044 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
10045 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010046
10047 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010048 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10049 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
10050 if (NewInVal != InVal)
10051 InVal = 0;
10052 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10053 }
10054
10055 Value *PhiVal;
10056 if (InVal) {
10057 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
10058 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
10059 PhiVal = InVal;
10060 delete NewPN;
10061 } else {
10062 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10063 PhiVal = NewPN;
10064 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010065
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010066 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010067 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010068 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010069 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010070 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010071 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010072 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010073 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010074 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
10075
10076 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
10077 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
10078 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
10079 if (isVolatile)
10080 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
10081 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
10082
10083 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010084}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010085
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010086/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
10087/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010088static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
10089 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010090 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
10091 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
10092
10093 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010094 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010095 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +000010096
10097 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10098 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
10099 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010100
10101 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
10102 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010103
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010104 return false;
10105}
10106
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010107/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
10108/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
10109/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10110static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
10111 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
10112 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
10113 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
10114 return true;
10115
10116 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10117 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
10118 return false;
10119
10120 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
10121 // the value.
10122 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10123 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
10124 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
10125 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10126 return false;
10127 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
10128 return false;
10129 }
10130
10131 return true;
10132}
10133
10134
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010135// PHINode simplification
10136//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010137Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +000010138 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010139 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +000010140
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010141 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
10142 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
10143
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010144 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
10145 // reducing code size.
10146 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
10147 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
10148 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
10149 return Result;
10150
10151 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
10152 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
10153 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010154 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
10155 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
10156 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010157 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010158 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
10159 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
10160 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
10161 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010162
10163 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
10164 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
10165 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
10166 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
10167 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
10168 // late.
10169 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
10170 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
10171 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
10172 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
10173 }
10174 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010175
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010176 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
10177 // same value, for example:
10178 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10179 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
10180 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
10181 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
10182 {
10183 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
10184 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
10185 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
10186 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
10187 ++InValNo;
10188
10189 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
10190 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
10191
10192 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
10193 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
10194 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
10195 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
10196 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
10197 break;
10198 }
10199
10200 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
10201 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
10202 // the value.
10203 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
10204 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
10205 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10206 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
10207 }
10208 }
10209 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +000010210 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010211}
10212
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010213static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
10214 Instruction *InsertPoint,
10215 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +000010216 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10217 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010218 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
10219 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
10220 // used for address computation.
10221 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
10222 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
10223 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
10224 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010225}
10226
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010227
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010228Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010229 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +000010230 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010231 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010232 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010233 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010234
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010235 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
10236 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
10237
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010238 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
10239 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
10240 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
10241
10242 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010243 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010244
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010245 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
10246 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010247
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010248 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010249 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP.op_begin() + 1, e = GEP.op_end();
10250 i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010251 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010252 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*i)) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +000010253 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
10254 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
10255 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
10256 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
10257 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
10258 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
10259 MadeChange = true;
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010260 *i = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010261 }
10262 }
10263 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010264 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000010265 // to what we need. If narrower, sign-extend it to what we need.
10266 // If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010267 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
10268 // obvious.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010269 Value *Op = *i;
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010270 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000010271 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010272 *i = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000010273 MadeChange = true;
10274 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010275 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
10276 GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010277 *i = Op;
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010278 MadeChange = true;
10279 }
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000010280 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
10281 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
10282 *i = ConstantExpr::getSExt(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
10283 MadeChange = true;
10284 } else {
10285 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::SExt, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
10286 GEP);
10287 *i = Op;
10288 MadeChange = true;
10289 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010290 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010291 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010292 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010293 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
10294
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010295 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
10296 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
10297 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010298 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10299 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))) {
10300 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
10301 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
10302 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
10303 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +000010304 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
10305 if (I != BCI) {
10306 I->takeName(BCI);
10307 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
10308 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
10309 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010310 return &GEP;
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +000010311 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010312 }
10313 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
10314 }
10315 }
10316
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010317 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
10318 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
10319 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
10320 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010321 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +000010322 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010323 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000010324
10325 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010326 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
10327 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
10328 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
10329 //
10330 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
10331 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
10332 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
10333
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010334 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010335
10336 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
10337 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
10338 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
10339 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +000010340 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010341
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010342 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010343 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +000010344 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
10345 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
10346 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010347 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010348 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
10349 Sum = GO1;
10350 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
10351 Sum = SO1;
10352 } else {
10353 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
10354 // target's pointer size.
10355 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
10356 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010357 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010358 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010359 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010360 } else {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010361 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
10362 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010363 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010364 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010365
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010366 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010367 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010368 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010369 } else {
10370 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010371 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
10372 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010373 }
10374 }
10375 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010376 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
10377 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
10378 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010379 Sum = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +000010380 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010381 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010382 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010383
10384 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
10385 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
10386 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
10387 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
10388 return &GEP;
10389 } else {
10390 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10391 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
10392 Indices.push_back(Sum);
10393 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
10394 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010395 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010396 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010397 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010398 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000010399 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10400 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010401 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
10402 }
10403
10404 if (!Indices.empty())
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010405 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
10406 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010407
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010408 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010409 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
10410 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
10411
10412 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010413 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010414 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
10415 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
10416 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
10417
10418 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010419 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
10420 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010421
10422 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
10423 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
10424 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010425 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010426 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
10427 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
10428 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010429 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
10430 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010431 //
10432 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
10433 //
10434 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
10435 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
10436 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
10437 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
10438 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
10439 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
10440 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
10441 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
10442 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
10443 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
10444 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
10445 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
10446 return &GEP;
10447 }
10448 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
10449 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010450 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
10451 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010452 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
10453 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
10454 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010455 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
10456 TD->getABITypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010457 Value *Idx[2];
10458 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10459 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010460 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010461 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010462 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
10463 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010464 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010465
10466 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010467 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010468 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010469 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010470
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010471 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010472 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010473 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010474
10475 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
10476 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
10477 Value *NewIdx = 0;
10478 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
10479 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
10480 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
10481 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
10482 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +000010483 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010484 Scale = CI;
10485 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
10486 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
10487 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +000010488 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10489 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
10490 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010491 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10492 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
10493 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
10494 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10495 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10496 }
10497 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010498
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010499 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010500 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
10501 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
10502 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
10503 if (Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
10504 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
10505 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
10506 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010507 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010508 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010509 false /*ZExt*/);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010510 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010511 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
10512 }
10513
10514 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010515 Value *Idx[2];
10516 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10517 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010518 Instruction *NewGEP =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010519 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010520 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
10521 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
10522 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010523 }
10524 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010525 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010526 }
10527
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010528 return 0;
10529}
10530
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010531Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
10532 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010533 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010534 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10535 const Type *NewTy =
10536 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010537 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010538
10539 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
10540 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010541 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010542 else {
10543 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010544 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010545 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010546
10547 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010548
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010549 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
10550 // allocas if possible...
10551 //
10552 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
10553 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
10554
10555 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
10556 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
10557 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010558 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010559 Value *Idx[2];
10560 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
10561 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010562 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::Create(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
10563 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010564
10565 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
10566 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010567 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010568 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10569 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010570 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010571 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010572
10573 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
10574 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
10575 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010576 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010577 TD->getABITypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010578 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
10579
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010580 return 0;
10581}
10582
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010583Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
10584 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
10585
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010586 // free undef -> unreachable.
10587 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
10588 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +000010589 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000010590 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010591 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10592 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010593
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010594 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
10595 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010596 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010597 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010598
10599 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
10600 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
10601 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
10602 return &FI;
10603 }
10604
10605 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
10606 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10607 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10608 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
10609 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
10610 return &FI;
10611 }
10612 }
10613
10614 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
10615 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
10616 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
10617 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10618 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
10619 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010620
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010621 return 0;
10622}
10623
10624
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010625/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010626static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010627 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010628 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010629 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010630
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010631 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
10632 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
10633 // directly if string length is small enough.
Evan Cheng0ff39b32008-06-30 07:31:25 +000010634 std::string Str;
10635 if (GetConstantStringInfo(CE->getOperand(0), Str) && !Str.empty()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010636 unsigned len = Str.length();
10637 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
10638 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10639 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
10640 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010641 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
10642 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
10643 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
10644 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
10645 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10646 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10647 }
10648 } else {
10649 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
10650 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10651 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10652 }
10653 // Append NULL at the end.
10654 SingleChar = 0;
10655 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10656 }
10657 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(StrVal);
10658 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010659 }
10660 }
10661 }
10662
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010663 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010664 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010665 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010666
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010667 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010668 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010669 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10670 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10671 // constants.
10672 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10673 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10674 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010675 Value *Idxs[2];
10676 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10677 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010678 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10679 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10680 }
10681
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010682 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010683 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000010684 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
10685 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
10686 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010687 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10688 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010689
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010690 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
10691 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
10692 // the result of the loaded value.
10693 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
10694 CI->getName(),
10695 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
10696 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010697 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010698 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010699 }
10700 }
10701 return 0;
10702}
10703
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010704/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010705/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
10706/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
10707/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
10708static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010709 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
10710 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
10711
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010712 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010713 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010714 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010715 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010716
10717 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
10718 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010719 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
10720 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
10721 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010722 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
10723
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010724 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010725 --BBI;
10726
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010727 // If we see a free or a call (which might do a free) the pointer could be
10728 // marked invalid.
10729 if (isa<FreeInst>(BBI) || isa<CallInst>(BBI))
10730 return false;
10731
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010732 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10733 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010734 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010735 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010736 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010737
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010738 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010739 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010740}
10741
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010742/// equivalentAddressValues - Test if A and B will obviously have the same
10743/// value. This includes recognizing that %t0 and %t1 will have the same
10744/// value in code like this:
10745/// %t0 = getelementptr @a, 0, 3
10746/// store i32 0, i32* %t0
10747/// %t1 = getelementptr @a, 0, 3
10748/// %t2 = load i32* %t1
10749///
10750static bool equivalentAddressValues(Value *A, Value *B) {
10751 // Test if the values are trivially equivalent.
10752 if (A == B) return true;
10753
10754 // Test if the values come form identical arithmetic instructions.
10755 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(A) ||
10756 isa<CastInst>(A) ||
10757 isa<PHINode>(A) ||
10758 isa<GetElementPtrInst>(A))
10759 if (Instruction *BI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(B))
10760 if (cast<Instruction>(A)->isIdenticalTo(BI))
10761 return true;
10762
10763 // Otherwise they may not be equivalent.
10764 return false;
10765}
10766
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010767Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
10768 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000010769
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010770 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010771 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op);
10772 if (KnownAlign >
10773 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
10774 LI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010775 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10776
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010777 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010778 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010779 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010780 return Res;
10781
10782 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
10783 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010784
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010785 // Do really simple store-to-load forwarding and load CSE, to catch cases
10786 // where there are several consequtive memory accesses to the same location,
10787 // separated by a few arithmetic operations.
10788 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI;
10789 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != LI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
10790 --ScanInsts) {
10791 --BBI;
10792
10793 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
10794 if (equivalentAddressValues(SI->getOperand(1), LI.getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010795 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010796 } else if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10797 if (equivalentAddressValues(LIB->getOperand(0), LI.getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010798 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010799 }
10800
10801 // Don't skip over things that can modify memory.
10802 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
10803 break;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010804 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010805
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010806 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10807 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
10808 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10809 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
10810 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010811 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10812 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10813 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10814 // CFG.
10815 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10816 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10817 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10818 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010819 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010820
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010821 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010822 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010823 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10824 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
10825 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010826 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
10827 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
10828 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010829 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10830 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010831 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010832 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010833
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010834 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
10835 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010836 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010837 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010838
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010839 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010840 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010841 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
10842 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010843 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000010844 if (Constant *V =
10845 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010846 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010847 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
10848 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10849 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10850 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10851 // CFG.
10852 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10853 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10854 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10855 }
10856
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010857 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010858 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010859 return Res;
10860 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010861 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010862 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010863
10864 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
10865 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
Duncan Sands5d0392c2008-10-01 15:25:41 +000010866 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op->getUnderlyingObject())){
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010867 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
10868 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
10869 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
10870 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
10871 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10872 }
10873 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000010874
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010875 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010876 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
10877 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
10878 // exposes redundancy in the code.
10879 //
10880 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
10881 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
10882 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
10883 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
10884 // unconditionally.
10885 //
10886 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
10887 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010888 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
10889 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010890 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010891 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010892 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010893 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010894 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010895 }
10896
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000010897 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
10898 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
10899 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10900 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
10901 return &LI;
10902 }
10903
10904 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
10905 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
10906 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10907 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
10908 return &LI;
10909 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010910 }
10911 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010912 return 0;
10913}
10914
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000010915/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010916/// when possible.
10917static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
10918 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
10919 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
10920
10921 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10922 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
10923 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10924
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010925 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010926 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10927 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10928 // constants.
10929 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10930 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10931 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010932 Value* Idxs[2];
10933 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10934 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010935 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10936 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10937 }
10938
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010939 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
10940 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10941 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010942
10943 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010944 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
10945 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010946 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010947 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010948 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
10949 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
10950 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
10951 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
10952 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010953 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010954 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +000010955 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010956 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
10957 }
10958 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010959 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010960 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010961 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010962 CastInst::Create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010963 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010964 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
10965 }
10966 }
10967 }
10968 return 0;
10969}
10970
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010971Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
10972 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
10973 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
10974
10975 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010976 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010977 ++NumCombined;
10978 return 0;
10979 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010980
10981 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
10982 // alloca dead.
Chris Lattnercea1fdd2008-04-29 04:58:38 +000010983 if (Ptr->hasOneUse() && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010984 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
10985 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10986 ++NumCombined;
10987 return 0;
10988 }
10989
10990 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
10991 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
10992 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
10993 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10994 ++NumCombined;
10995 return 0;
10996 }
10997 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010998
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010999 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000011000 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr);
11001 if (KnownAlign >
11002 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
11003 SI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011004 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
11005
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011006 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
11007 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
11008 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
11009 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
11010 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
11011 --ScanInsts) {
11012 --BBI;
11013
11014 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
11015 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011016 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && equivalentAddressValues(PrevSI->getOperand(1),
11017 SI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011018 ++NumDeadStore;
11019 ++BBI;
11020 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
11021 continue;
11022 }
11023 break;
11024 }
11025
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011026 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
11027 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
11028 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
11029 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011030 if (LI == Val && equivalentAddressValues(LI->getOperand(0), Ptr) &&
11031 !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011032 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11033 ++NumCombined;
11034 return 0;
11035 }
11036 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
11037 // may not be dead.
11038 break;
11039 }
11040
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011041 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000011042 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011043 break;
11044 }
11045
11046
11047 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011048
11049 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
11050 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
11051 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
11052 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
11053 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011054 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011055 ++NumCombined;
11056 }
11057 return 0; // Do not modify these!
11058 }
11059
11060 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
11061 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011062 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011063 ++NumCombined;
11064 return 0;
11065 }
11066
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011067 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
11068 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011069 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011070 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11071 return Res;
11072 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011073 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011074 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11075 return Res;
11076
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011077
11078 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
11079 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011080 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011081 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011082 if (BI->isUnconditional())
11083 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
11084 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011085
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011086 return 0;
11087}
11088
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011089/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
11090/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
11091/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11092///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011093/// Simplify things like:
11094/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
11095/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11096///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011097bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
11098 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
11099
11100 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
11101 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
11102 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011103 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011104
11105 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
11106 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011107 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
11108 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011109 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011110 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011111 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011112 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011113 return false;
11114
11115 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011116 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011117 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011118 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011119 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011120 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011121 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000011122
11123 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
11124 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
11125 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
11126 return false;
11127
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011128 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
11129 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011130 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011131 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011132 return false;
11133
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011134 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
11135 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
11136 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
11137 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
11138 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
11139 --BBI;
11140 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
11141 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11142 return false;
11143 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011144 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011145 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
11146 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
11147 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
11148 return false;
11149
11150 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011151 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
11152 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011153 for (;; --BBI) {
11154 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
11155 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
11156 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11157 return false;
11158 break;
11159 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011160 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
11161 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
11162 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011163 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
11164 return false;
11165 }
11166
11167 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011168 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
11169 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011170 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
11171 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011172 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011173 return false;
11174 }
11175 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011176
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011177 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011178 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
11179 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011180 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011181 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
11182 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011183 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
11184 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011185 }
11186
11187 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
11188 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011189 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011190 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
11191 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
11192
11193 // Nuke the old stores.
11194 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11195 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
11196 ++NumCombined;
11197 return true;
11198}
11199
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011200
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011201Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
11202 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000011203 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011204 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
11205 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
11206 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
11207 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
11208 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11209 BI.setCondition(X);
11210 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11211 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
11212 return &BI;
11213 }
11214
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011215 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
11216 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
11217 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
11218 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
11219 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
11220 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
11221 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011222 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011223 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
11224 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011225 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11226 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
11227 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11228 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011229 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011230 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011231 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011232 return &BI;
11233 }
11234
11235 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
11236 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
11237 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
11238 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
11239 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
11240 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
11241 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
11242 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011243 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011244 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
11245 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011246 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011247 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011248 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11249 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011250 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011251 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011252 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011253 return &BI;
11254 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011255
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011256 return 0;
11257}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011258
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011259Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
11260 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
11261 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
11262 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
11263 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
11264 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
11265 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011266 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011267 AddRHS));
11268 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011269 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011270 return &SI;
11271 }
11272 }
11273 return 0;
11274}
11275
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011276Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011277 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011278
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011279 if (!EV.hasIndices())
11280 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
11281
11282 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
11283 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
11284 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
11285
11286 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
11287 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
11288
11289 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
11290 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
11291 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
11292 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
11293 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
11294 // first index
11295 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
11296 else
11297 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
11298 }
11299 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
11300 }
11301 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
11302 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
11303 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
11304 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
11305 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
11306 exti != exte && insi != inse;
11307 ++exti, ++insi) {
11308 if (*insi != *exti)
11309 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
11310 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
11311 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
11312 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
11313 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11314 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
11315 // with
11316 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
11317 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11318 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
11319 }
11320 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
11321 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
11322 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
11323 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
11324 // with "i32 42"
11325 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
11326 if (exti == exte) {
11327 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
11328 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
11329 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
11330 // with
11331 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
11332 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
11333 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
11334 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
11335 Value *NewEV = InsertNewInstBefore(
11336 ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11337 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end()),
11338 EV);
11339 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11340 insi, inse);
11341 }
11342 if (insi == inse)
11343 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
11344 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
11345 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
11346 // i.e., replace
11347 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11348 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
11349 // with
11350 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
11351 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11352 exti, exte);
11353 }
11354 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
11355 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
11356 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
11357 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011358 return 0;
11359}
11360
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011361/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
11362/// is to leave as a vector operation.
11363static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
11364 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11365 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011366 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011367 if (isConstant) return true;
11368 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
11369 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
11370 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
11371 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
11372 return false;
11373 return true;
11374 }
11375 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
11376 if (!I) return false;
11377
11378 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
11379 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
11380 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
11381 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
11382 return true;
11383 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
11384 return true;
11385 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
11386 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
11387 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11388 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11389 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011390 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
11391 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
11392 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11393 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11394 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011395
11396 return false;
11397}
11398
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000011399/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
11400///
11401/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
11402/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011403static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
11404 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
11405 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11406 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
11407 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11408 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
11409
11410 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011411 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011412 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
11413 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011414 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
11415 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011416 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011417 return Result;
11418}
11419
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011420/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
11421/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
11422/// extracted from the vector.
11423static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011424 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
11425 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011426 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
11427 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011428 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11429
11430 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
11431 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11432 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11433 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011434 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011435 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
11436 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11437 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011438 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
11439 return 0;
11440 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011441
11442 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
11443 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011444 if (EltNo == IIElt)
11445 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011446
11447 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
11448 // vector input.
11449 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011450 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011451 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
11452 if (InEl < Width)
11453 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
11454 else if (InEl < Width*2)
11455 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
11456 else
11457 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011458 }
11459
11460 // Otherwise, we don't know.
11461 return 0;
11462}
11463
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011464Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000011465 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000011466 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11467 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11468
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000011469 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000011470 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11471 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
11472
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011473 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000011474 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
11475 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
11476 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011477 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011478 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011479 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
11480 op0 = 0;
11481 break;
11482 }
11483 if (op0)
11484 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011485 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011486
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011487 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
11488 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011489 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000011490 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
11491 unsigned VectorWidth =
11492 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
11493
11494 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
11495 // crashing the code below.
11496 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
11497 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11498
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011499 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
11500 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
11501 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000011502 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011503 uint64_t UndefElts;
11504 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011505 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011506 UndefElts)) {
11507 EI.setOperand(0, V);
11508 return &EI;
11509 }
11510 }
11511
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011512 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011513 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000011514
11515 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
11516 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
11517 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
11518 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
11519 if (const VectorType *VT =
11520 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
11521 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
11522 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
11523 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
11524 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011525 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011526
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011527 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011528 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
11529 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
11530 // profitable to do so
11531 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011532 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
11533 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
11534 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
11535 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
11536 EI.getName()+".lhs");
11537 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
11538 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
11539 EI.getName()+".rhs");
11540 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
11541 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011542 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011543 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011544 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000011545 unsigned AS =
11546 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +000011547 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(I->getOperand(0),
11548 PointerType::get(EI.getType(), AS),EI);
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000011549 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
11550 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName()+".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011551 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
11552 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011553 }
11554 }
11555 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
11556 // Extracting the inserted element?
11557 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
11558 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
11559 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
11560 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
11561 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
11562 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11563 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
11564 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
11565 return &EI;
11566 }
11567 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
11568 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
11569 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011570 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11571 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011572 Value *Src;
11573 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
11574 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
11575 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
11576 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
11577 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
11578 } else {
11579 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000011580 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011581 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011582 }
11583 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011584 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011585 return 0;
11586}
11587
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011588/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
11589/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
11590/// Otherwise, return false.
11591static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
11592 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
11593 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
11594 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011595 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011596
11597 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011598 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011599 return true;
11600 } else if (V == LHS) {
11601 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011602 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011603 return true;
11604 } else if (V == RHS) {
11605 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011606 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011607 return true;
11608 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11609 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11610 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11611 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11612 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11613
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011614 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
11615 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011616 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011617
11618 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
11619 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11620 // transitively ok.
11621 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11622 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011623 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011624 return true;
11625 }
11626 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
11627 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011628 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11629 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011630 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011631
11632 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
11633 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
11634 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11635 // transitively ok.
11636 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11637 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
11638 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011639 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011640 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011641 } else {
11642 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011643 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011644 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011645
11646 }
11647 return true;
11648 }
11649 }
11650 }
11651 }
11652 }
11653 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
11654
11655 return false;
11656}
11657
11658/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
11659/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
11660/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011661static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011662 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011663 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011664 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011665 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011666 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011667
11668 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011669 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011670 return V;
11671 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011672 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011673 return V;
11674 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11675 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11676 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11677 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11678 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11679
11680 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11681 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11682 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11683 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011684 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
11685 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011686
11687 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
11688 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011689 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
11690 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
11691 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011692 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011693 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011694 return V;
11695 }
11696
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011697 if (VecOp == RHS) {
11698 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011699 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
11700 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
11701 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011702 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011703 }
11704 return V;
11705 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011706
11707 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
11708 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
11709 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
11710 return EI->getOperand(0);
11711
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011712 }
11713 }
11714 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011715 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011716
11717 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
11718 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011719 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011720 return V;
11721}
11722
11723Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
11724 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
11725 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
11726 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
11727
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000011728 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
11729 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
11730 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11731
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011732 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
11733 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
11734 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11735 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11736 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
11737 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000011738 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
11739 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011740 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011741
11742 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
11743 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11744
11745 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
11746 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
11747
11748 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
11749 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
11750 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
11751 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11752
11753 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
11754 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
11755 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
11756 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
11757 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
11758 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
11759 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
11760 // Build a new shuffle mask.
11761 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
11762 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011763 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011764 else {
11765 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011766 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011767 NumVectorElts));
11768 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011769 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011770 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011771 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011772 }
11773
11774 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
11775 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
11776 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
11777 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011778 Value *RHS = 0;
11779 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
11780 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
11781 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011782 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011783 }
11784 }
11785 }
11786
11787 return 0;
11788}
11789
11790
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011791Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
11792 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11793 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011794 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011795
11796 bool MadeChange = false;
11797
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011798 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011799 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011800 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011801
11802 uint64_t UndefElts;
11803 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
11804 uint64_t AllOnesEltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
11805 if (VWidth <= 64 &&
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000011806 SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts)) {
11807 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11808 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011809 MadeChange = true;
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000011810 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011811
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011812 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
11813 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
11814 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
11815 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011816 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
11817 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11818 }
11819
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011820 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11821 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11822 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011823 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011824 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011825 else {
11826 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011827 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011828 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011829 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11830 } else {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011831 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011832 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
11833 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011834 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011835 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011836 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011837 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011838 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011839 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11840 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011841 MadeChange = true;
11842 }
11843
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011844 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011845 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011846
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011847 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11848 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
11849 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
11850 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
11851
11852 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
11853 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011854 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011855
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011856 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
11857 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11858 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011859
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011860 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
11861 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
11862 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
11863 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
11864 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
11865 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
11866 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
11867 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
11868 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
11869 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
11870 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
11871 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
11872
11873 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
11874 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
11875 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
11876 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
11877 else
11878 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
11879
11880 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
11881 // the replacement.
11882 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
11883 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11884 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11885 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011886 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011887 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011888 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011889 }
11890 }
11891 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
11892 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011893 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011894 }
11895 }
11896 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000011897
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011898 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
11899}
11900
11901
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011902
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011903
11904/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
11905/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
11906/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
11907/// end of its block.
11908static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
11909 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
11910
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000011911 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000011912 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
11913 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011914
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011915 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000011916 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
11917 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011918 return false;
11919
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011920 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
11921 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000011922 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
11923 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011924 Scan != E; ++Scan)
11925 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
11926 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011927 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011928
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011929 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011930
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000011931 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011932 ++NumSunkInst;
11933 return true;
11934}
11935
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011936
11937/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
11938/// all reachable code to the worklist.
11939///
11940/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
11941/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
11942/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
11943/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
11944/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
11945///
11946static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011947 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011948 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011949 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000011950 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011951 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011952
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011953 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11954 BB = Worklist.back();
11955 Worklist.pop_back();
11956
11957 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
11958 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
11959
11960 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
11961 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011962
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011963 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
11964 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
11965 ++NumDeadInst;
11966 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
11967 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11968 continue;
11969 }
11970
11971 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
11972 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
11973 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
11974 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
11975 ++NumConstProp;
11976 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11977 continue;
11978 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000011979
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011980 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011981 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011982
11983 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
11984 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
11985 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
11986 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
11987 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
11988 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011989 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011990 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011991 continue;
11992 }
11993 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
11994 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
11995 // See if this is an explicit destination.
11996 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11997 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011998 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011999 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012000 continue;
12001 }
12002
12003 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
12004 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
12005 continue;
12006 }
12007 }
12008
12009 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12010 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012011 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012012}
12013
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012014bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012015 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000012016 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012017
12018 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
12019 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012020
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012021 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012022 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
12023 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
12024 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000012025 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012026 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000012027
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012028 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
12029 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
12030 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
12031 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
12032 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
12033 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
12034 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
12035 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000012036
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012037 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012038 ++NumDeadInst;
12039
12040 if (!I->use_empty())
12041 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
12042 I->eraseFromParent();
12043 }
12044 }
12045 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012046
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012047 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
12048 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
12049 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012050
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012051 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012052 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012053 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012054 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000012055 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012056 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012057
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012058 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000012059
12060 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012061 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012062 continue;
12063 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012064
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012065 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000012066 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012067 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000012068
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012069 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000012070 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000012071 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
12072
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012073 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012074 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012075 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012076 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012077 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012078
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000012079 if (TD && I->getType()->getTypeID() == Type::VoidTyID) {
12080 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
12081 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i) {
12082 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i)) {
12083 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, TD))
12084 i->set(NewC);
12085 }
12086 }
12087 }
12088
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012089 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000012090 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012091 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
12092 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
12093 if (UserParent != BB) {
12094 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
12095 // See if the user is one of our successors.
12096 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
12097 if (*SI == UserParent) {
12098 UserIsSuccessor = true;
12099 break;
12100 }
12101
12102 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
12103 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
12104 // otherwise), we can keep going.
12105 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
12106 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
12107 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
12108 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
12109 }
12110 }
12111
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012112 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000012113#ifndef NDEBUG
12114 std::string OrigI;
12115#endif
12116 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012117 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000012118 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012119 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012120 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012121 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
12122 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012123
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012124 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
12125 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
12126
12127 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012128 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012129 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012130
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012131 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
12132 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012133
12134 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
12135 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000012136 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
12137
12138 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
12139 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
12140 ++InsertPos;
12141
12142 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012143
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012144 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
12145 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012146 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000012147
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012148 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
12149 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012150 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012151
12152 // Erase the old instruction.
12153 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000012154 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012155#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000012156 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
12157 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012158#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012159
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012160 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
12161 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012162 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
12163 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
12164 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012165 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012166
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012167 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012168 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012169 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012170 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012171 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012172 AddToWorkList(I);
12173 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012174 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012175 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012176 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012177 }
12178 }
12179
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012180 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000012181
12182 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
12183 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012184 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012185}
12186
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012187
12188bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000012189 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
12190
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012191 bool EverMadeChange = false;
12192
12193 // Iterate while there is work to do.
12194 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000012195 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012196 EverMadeChange = true;
12197 return EverMadeChange;
12198}
12199
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000012200FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012201 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012202}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000012203
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +000012204